blob: 3468c78f389a4b970f9c76fe2ef4547053c4d4d2 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Willy Tarreau4c7588d2023-03-28 13:58:56 +02006 2023/03/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001018.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
1038.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001239.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
193This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
194streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200198
199HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200200head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200201streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
202other streams.
203
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
205connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
206leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100207start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
208processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
209waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200210
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200211HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100212 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
213 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100214 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100215 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200216 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100217
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219
2201.2. HTTP request
221-----------------
222
223First, let's consider this HTTP request :
224
225 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100226 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
228 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
229 3 User-agent: my small browser
230 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
231 5 Accept: image/png
232
233
2341.2.1. The Request line
235-----------------------
236
237Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
238
239 - a METHOD : GET
240 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
242
243All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
244which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
245followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
246is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
247desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
248the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
249
250The URI itself can have several forms :
251
252 - A "relative URI" :
253
254 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
257 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
258
259 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
260
261 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
262
263 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
264 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
265 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
266 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
267 must accept this form too.
268
269 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
270 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
271 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
274 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
275 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
276 other protocols too.
277
278In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
279mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
280on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
281It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
282specific to the language, framework or application in use.
283
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100284HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100285assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.2.2. The request headers
289--------------------------
290
291The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
292beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
293an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
294Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
295values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
296encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
297the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
298define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
299
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100300Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100302"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200303as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
304normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
305representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
306HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307
308The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
309that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
310is one valid form of empty line.
311
312Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
313headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
314about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
315application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
316
317Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000318 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
320 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
321 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
322
323
3241.3. HTTP response
325------------------
326
327An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
328messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
329
330 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100331 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
333 2 Content-length: 350
334 3 Content-Type: text/html
335
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
337codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
338response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100339continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
340the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
341following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
342sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
343(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
344correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
345such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
346state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400347over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100348if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
349information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003521.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353------------------------
354
355Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
356
357 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
358 - a status code : 200
359 - a reason : OK
360
361The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100362 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
363 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
364 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
365 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
366 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000368Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100369"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
371messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
372or "Authentication Required".
373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100374HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375
376 Code When / reason
377 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
378 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
379 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
380 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100381 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
382 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 400 for an invalid or too large request
384 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
385 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100387 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100389 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
390 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400391 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200392 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400393 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100394 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200395 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200396 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200397 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
398 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
399 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
400
401The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4024.2).
403
404
4051.3.2. The response headers
406---------------------------
407
408Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
409the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
410details.
411
412
4132. Configuring HAProxy
414----------------------
415
4162.1. Configuration file format
417------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
419HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
420
421 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700423 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100424 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200425
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100426The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
427a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100428
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100429 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
430
431 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
432
433 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
434 tab characters
435
436 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
437 keyword sequences listed in this document
438
439 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
440 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
441 parts of the configuration, or expressions
442
443 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
444 are supported
445
446 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
447 section
448
449This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
450generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
451figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
452
453First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
454the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
455a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
456word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
457follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
458the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
459the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
460the parts that need to be addressed.
461
462A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
463requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
464extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
465the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
466section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
467section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
468not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
469
470A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
471each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
472a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
473start a new one.
474
475Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
476that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
477applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
478"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
479processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
480ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
481which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
482In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
483of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
484identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
485such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4862, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
487
488 listen foo
489 bind :80
490
491 listen bar
492 bind :81
493
494Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
495spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
496of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
497following configurations are strictly equivalent:
498
499 global#this is the global section
500 daemon#daemonize
501 frontend foo
502 mode http # or tcp
503
504and:
505
506 global
507 daemon
508
509 # this is the public web frontend
510 frontend foo
511 mode http
512
513The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
514new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
515other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
516section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
517section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
518at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
519
520Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
521are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
522editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
523support automatic indent.
524
525In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
526positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
527modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
528anymore, and is not recommended.
529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200530
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005312.2. Quoting and escaping
532-------------------------
533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
535that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
536possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
537in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
538('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
541very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
542the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
543also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
544delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
545word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
546remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100548If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
549(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
550
551Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
552backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200553
554 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
555 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
556 \\ to use a backslash
557 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
558 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
559
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100560In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
561C-language representation:
562
563 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
564 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
565 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
566 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
567
568Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
569or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
570of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200571
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100572 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200573 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
574 # hash as a comment start
575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
577evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
578dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
579backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200580
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100581Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
582character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
583is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
586entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
587name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
588represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300589hence its absence there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100591 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
592 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
593 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300594 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
595 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" |
596 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
597 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" |
598 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100599 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300600 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100601 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300602 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100603 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300604 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300606 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
607 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" |
608 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100609 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300610 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200611
612 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100613 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200614 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
615 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
616 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
617 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
618 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
619
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100620There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
621necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
622by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
623they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
624escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
625characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
626case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
627if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
628own quotes.
629
630The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600631quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500632not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100633quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
634
635Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
636arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
637
638 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
639 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
640
641Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
642"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
643cannot write:
644
645 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
646
647because we would like the string to cut like this:
648
649 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
650 |---------|----|-|
651 arg1 _/ / /
652 arg2 __________/ /
653 arg3 ______________/
654
655but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
656parenthesis then garbage:
657
658 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
659 |--------|--------|
660 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
661 trailing garbage _________/
662
663The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
664quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
665processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
666this word:
667
668 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
669 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
670 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
671
672So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
673still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
674the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
675the second level:
676
677 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
678 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
679 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
680 |---------||----|-|
681 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
682 arg2=blah ___________/ /
683 arg3=g _______________/
684
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500685Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100686double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
687
688 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
689 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
690 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
691 |---------||----|-|
692 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
693 arg2 ___________/ /
694 arg3 _______________/
695
696When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
697appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
698string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
699thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
700
701 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
702 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
703 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
704 |-------------| |-----||-|
705 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
706 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
707 arg3 ______________________/
708
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400709Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600710that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100711quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
712single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
713level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
714
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600715Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
716if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
717or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
718
719 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
720 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
721 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
722
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100723When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
724double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600725and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100726a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
727a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
728the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
729regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
730around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
731more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200732
733
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007342.3. Environment variables
735--------------------------
736
737HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
738interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
739configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
740optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
741shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200742underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
743list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
744arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100745before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
746use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
747next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
748existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200749
750 Example:
751
752 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
753
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100754 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200755
756 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
757
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200758Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
759file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200760
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200761* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
762 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
763
764* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
765 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
766 directory.
767
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100768* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
769 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
770 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
771
772 Example:
773 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
774 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
775
776* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
777 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
778
779* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
780 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
781
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200782* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
783
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500784* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200785 processes, separated by semicolons.
786
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500787* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200788 CLI, separated by semicolons.
789
William Lallemandd4c0be62023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100790* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
791 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
792 updating the binary and reloading.
793
Sébaastien Gross2a1bcf12023-02-23 12:54:25 -0500794* HAPROXY_BRANCH: contains the HAProxy branch version (such as "2.8"). It does
795 not contain the full version number. It can be useful in case of migration
796 if resources (such as maps or certificates) are in a path containing the
797 branch number.
798
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200799In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
800regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
801only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
802
803* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
804
805* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
806 starting at one.
807
808* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
809 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
810 first section.
811
812These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
813if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
814section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
815"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
816proxies.
817
818This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
819logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
820to name some config objects like servers for example.
821
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200822See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200823
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100824
8252.4. Conditional blocks
826-----------------------
827
828It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
829some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
830ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
831configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
832versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
833preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
834text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
835lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
836switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
837are defined to form conditional blocks:
838
839 - .if <condition>
840 - .elif <condition>
841 - .else
842 - .endif
843
844The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
845as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
846matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
847there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
848only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
849".elif" of a block.
850
851Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
852ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
853as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
854
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200855Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
856See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
857
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200858The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
859expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100860
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100861 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
862 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200863 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200864 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530865 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
866 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200867 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
868 from left to right until one returns false
869 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
870 from right to left until one returns true
871
872Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
873operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200874
875The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
876
877 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
878 exists, regardless of its contents
879
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200880 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
881 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
882 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
883
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200884 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
885 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
Christopher Fauleta1fdad72023-02-20 17:55:58 +0100886 - strstr(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the second string is found in the first one
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200887
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200888 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
889 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
890 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
891 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
892
893 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
894 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
895 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
896 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
897
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100898 - enabled(<opt>) : returns true if the option <opt> is enabled at
899 run-time. Only a subset of options are supported:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +0100900 POLL, EPOLL, KQUEUE, EVPORTS, SPLICE,
901 GETADDRINFO, REUSEPORT, FAST-FORWARD,
902 SERVER-SSL-VERIFY-NONE
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100903
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200904Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100905
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200906 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
907 listen mwcli_px
908 bind :1111
909 ...
910 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100911
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200912 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
913 bind :80
914 .endif
915
916 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200917 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200918 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200919 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200920 .endif
921
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200922 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200923 bind :443 ssl crt ...
924 .endif
925
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200926 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
927 profiling.memory on
928 .endif
929
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200930 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
931 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
932 .endif
933
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200934Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100935
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200936 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100937 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
938 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
939 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
940
941Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
942"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
943fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
944provide advice to the user.
945
946Example:
947
948 .if "${A}"
949 .if "${B}"
950 .notice "A=1, B=1"
951 .elif "${C}"
952 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
953 .elif "${D}"
954 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
955 .else
956 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
957 .endif
958 .else
959 .notice "A=0"
960 .endif
961
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200962 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
963 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
964
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100965
9662.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200967----------------
968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100969Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100970values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
971otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
972numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
973for every keyword. Supported units are :
974
975 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
976 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
977 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
978 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
979 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
980 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
981
982
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009832.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200984-------------
985
986 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
987 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
988 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
989 global
990 daemon
991 maxconn 256
992
993 defaults
994 mode http
995 timeout connect 5000ms
996 timeout client 50000ms
997 timeout server 50000ms
998
999 frontend http-in
1000 bind *:80
1001 default_backend servers
1002
1003 backend servers
1004 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1005
1006
1007 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
1008 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
1009 global
1010 daemon
1011 maxconn 256
1012
1013 defaults
1014 mode http
1015 timeout connect 5000ms
1016 timeout client 50000ms
1017 timeout server 50000ms
1018
1019 listen http-in
1020 bind *:80
1021 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1022
1023
1024Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1025
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001026 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001027
1028
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010293. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030--------------------
1031
1032Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1033are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1034of them have command-line equivalents.
1035
1036The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1037
1038 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001039 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001040 - 51degrees-cache-size
1041 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001042 - 51degrees-difference
1043 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001044 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1045 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001046 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1047 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001048 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001049 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001050 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001051 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001052 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001053 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001054 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001055 - description
1056 - deviceatlas-json-file
1057 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001058 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001059 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001060 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001061 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001062 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001063 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001064 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001065 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001066 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1067 - h1-case-adjust
1068 - h1-case-adjust-file
1069 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001070 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001071 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1072 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1073 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1074 - httpclient.ssl.verify
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001075 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001076 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001077 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001078 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001079 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001080 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001081 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001082 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001083 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001084 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001085 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001086 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001087 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001088 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001090 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001091 - presetenv
1092 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001093 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001094 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001095 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001096 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001097 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001098 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001099 - ssl-default-bind-options
1100 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001101 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001102 - ssl-default-server-options
1103 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001104 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001105 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001106 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001107 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001108 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001109 - stats
1110 - strict-limits
1111 - uid
1112 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001113 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001114 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001115 - user
1116 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001117 - wurfl-data-file
1118 - wurfl-information-list
1119 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001121 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001122 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001123 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001124 - maxcompcpuusage
1125 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001127 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001128 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001129 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001130 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001131 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001132 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001133 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001134 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001135 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001136 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001137 - nokqueue
1138 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001139 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001140 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001141 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001142 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001143 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001144 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001145 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001146 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001147 - tune.buffers.limit
1148 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001149 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001150 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01001151 - tune.disable-fast-forward
Christopher Faulet760a3842023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001152 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001153 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001154 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001155 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001156 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001157 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001158 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001159 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001160 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001161 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001162 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001163 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001164 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001165 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1166 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001167 - tune.maxaccept
1168 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001169 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001170 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001171 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001172 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001173 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001174 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1175 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001176 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001177 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001178 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01001179 - tune.quic.max-frame-loss
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001180 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001181 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001182 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1183 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001184 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001185 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001186 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001187 - tune.sndbuf.client
1188 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001189 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001190 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001191 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1192 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1193 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001194 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1195 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001196 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001197 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1198 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001199 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01001200 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay
1201 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001202 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001203 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001204 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1205 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1206 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001207 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1208 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001209
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001210 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001211 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001212 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001213 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001214
1215
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012163.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001217------------------------------------
1218
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100121951degrees-data-file <file path>
1220 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1221 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1222
1223 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001224 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001225
122651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1227 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1228 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1229 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1230
1231 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001232 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001233
123451degrees-property-separator <char>
1235 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1236 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1237
1238 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001239 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001240
124151degrees-cache-size <number>
1242 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1243 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1244 By default, this cache is disabled.
1245
1246 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001247 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001248
124951degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1250 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1251 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1252
1253 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001254 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001255
125651degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1257 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1258 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1259
1260 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001261 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001262
126351degrees-drift <number>
1264 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1265
1266 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001267 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001268
126951degrees-difference <number>
1270 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1271
1272 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001273 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001274
127551degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1276 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1277 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1278
1279 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001280 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001281
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001282ca-base <dir>
1283 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001284 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1285 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1286 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001287
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001288chroot <jail dir>
1289 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1290 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1291 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1292 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1293 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001294 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001295
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001296close-spread-time <time>
1297 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1298 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1299 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1300 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1301 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1302 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1303 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1304 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001305 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1306 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1307 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1308 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1309 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001310
1311 Arguments :
1312 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001313 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1314 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001315
1316 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1317 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1318 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1319
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001320 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001321
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001322cluster-secret <secret>
1323 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1324 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1325 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1326 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001327 tokens.
1328
1329 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1330 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1331 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001332
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001333cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1334 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1335 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1336 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1337 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1338 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001339
1340 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1341
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001342 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001343 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1344 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1345 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1346 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1347 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1348 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1349 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
1350 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside
1351 of Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1352 either 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the
1353 processes or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously,
1354 multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will
1355 replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001356
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001357 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1358 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1359 on the machine's word size.
1360
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001361 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1362 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001363 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1364 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001365 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001366 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1367 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001368
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001369 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1370 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1371 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1372 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1373 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001374
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001375 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001376 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001377 # first 4 CPUs
1378
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001379 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1380 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001381 # word size.
1382
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001383 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001384 # and so on.
1385 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1386 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1387 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1388
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001389 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1390 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1391 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1392 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001393
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001394 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1395 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1396 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001397
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001398 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1399 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1400 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1401 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1402 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1403
1404 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1405 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1406 # group may have more than 64 threads.
1407 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39 80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1408 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39 80-119
1409 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79 120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1410 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79 120-159
1411
1412
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001413crt-base <dir>
1414 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001415 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1416 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001417
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001418daemon
1419 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1420 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001421 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1422 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001423
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001424default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001425 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001426 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1427 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1428 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1429 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1430 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1431 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1432 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1433 not start with a slash ('/'):
1434 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1435 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1436
1437 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1438 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1439 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1440 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1441 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1442 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1443 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1444 each of them.
1445
1446 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1447 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1448 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1449 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1450 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1451 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1452 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1453 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1454
1455 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1456 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001457 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001458 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1459 made easily relocatable.
1460
1461 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1462 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1463 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1464 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1465 consistent across all configuration files.
1466
1467 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1468 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1469 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1470 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1471 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1472 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1473 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1474 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1475
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001476description <text>
1477 Add a text that describes the instance.
1478
1479 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1480 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1481 "<" and ">" characters.
1482
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001483deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1484 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001485 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001486
1487deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001488 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001489 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1490
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001491deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001492 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1493 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1494 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001495
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001496deviceatlas-separator <char>
1497 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1498 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1499
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001500expose-experimental-directives
1501 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1502 the config file will be rejected.
1503
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001504external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001505 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1506 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001507 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1508 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1509 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1510 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1511 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001512
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001513fd-hard-limit <number>
1514 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1515 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1516 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1517 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1518 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1519 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1520 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1521 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1522 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1523 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1524 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1525 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1526
1527 global
1528 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1529 fd-hard-limit 50000
1530
1531 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1532
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001533gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001534 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001535 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1536 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001537 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001538 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001539 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001540
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001541grace <time>
1542 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1543
1544 Arguments :
1545 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1546 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1547 soft-stop operation.
1548
1549 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1550 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1551 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1552 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1553 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1554 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1555 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1556 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1557 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1558
1559 Example:
1560
1561 global
1562 grace 10s
1563
1564 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1565 frontend ext-check
1566 bind :9999
1567 monitor-uri /ext-check
1568 monitor fail if { stopping }
1569
1570 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1571 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1572 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1573 SIGUSR1 signal.
1574
1575 Example:
1576
1577 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1578 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1579 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1580 frontend ext-check
1581 bind :9999
1582 monitor-uri /ext-check
1583 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1584
1585 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1586
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001587group <group name>
1588 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1589 See also "gid" and "user".
1590
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001591h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1592 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1593
1594 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1595 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1596 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1597 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1598 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1599 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1600 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1601
1602 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1603 option may be set.
1604
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001605h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1606 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1607 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1608 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1609 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001610 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001611 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1612 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1613 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1614 specified in a proxy.
1615
1616 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1617 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1618 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1619 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1620 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1621 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1622 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1623
1624 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1625 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1626 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1627 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1628 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1629
1630 Example:
1631 global
1632 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1633
1634 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1635 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1636
1637h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1638 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1639 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1640 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1641 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1642 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1643 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1644 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1645 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1646
1647 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1648 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1649 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1650
1651 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1652 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1653
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001654h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1655 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1656 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1657 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1658 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1659 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1660 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1661 the keyword with "no'.
1662
1663hard-stop-after <time>
1664 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1665
1666 Arguments :
1667 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1668 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1669 SIGUSR1 signal.
1670
1671 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1672 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1673 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1674
1675 Example:
1676 global
1677 hard-stop-after 30s
1678
1679 See also: grace
1680
1681httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1682 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1683 to resolve.
1684
1685 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1686 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1687
1688 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1689 configuration error if it fails to load.
1690
1691httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1692 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1693 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1694 option is "ipv6".
1695
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001696httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1697 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1698 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1699 server line.
1700
1701 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1702 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1703 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1704
1705 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1706 configuration error if it fails.
1707
1708httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1709 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1710 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1711
1712 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1713 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1714
1715 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1716 configuration error if it fails.
1717
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001718insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001719 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001720 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1721 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1722 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1723 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1724 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1725 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1726 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001727 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001728 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1729 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1730 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1731 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1732 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1733 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1734 disable it.
1735
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001736insecure-setuid-wanted
1737 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1738 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1739 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1740 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001741 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001742 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001743 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001744 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1745 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001746 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001747 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1748 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1749 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1750 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1751
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001752issuers-chain-path <dir>
1753 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1754 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1755 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001756 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001757 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1758 "issuers-chain-path".
1759 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1760 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1761 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1762 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1763 will share the chain in memory.
1764
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001765localpeer <name>
1766 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1767 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1768 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1769 the configuration parsing.
1770
1771 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1772 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1773
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001774log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001775 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001776 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001777 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001778 configured with "log global".
1779
1780 <address> can be one of:
1781
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001782 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001783 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1784 port).
1785
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001786 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1787 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1788 port).
1789
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001790 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001791 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1792 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001793 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001794
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001795 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1796 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1797 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1798 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1799 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1800 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1801 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1802 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1803 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1804 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001805 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001806 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1807 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1808 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001809 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1810 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001811
1812 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1813 "fd@2", see above.
1814
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001815 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1816 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1817 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1818 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1819 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1820
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001821 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1822 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001823
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001824 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1825 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1826 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1827 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1828 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1829 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1830 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1831 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1832 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1833 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001834 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1835 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001836
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001837 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1838 one of the following :
1839
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001840 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1841 field is stripped. This is the default.
1842 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1843 rfc3164.
1844
1845 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001846 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1847
1848 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1849 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1850
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001851 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1852 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1853 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1854 designed to be used with a local log server.
1855
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001856 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1857 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1858 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1859 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1860 logger consumes.
1861
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001862 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1863 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1864 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1865 used with a local log server.
1866
1867 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1868 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1869 designed to be used with a local log server.
1870
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001871 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1872 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1873 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1874 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1875
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001876 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1877 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1878 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1879 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1880 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1881
1882 <sample_size>
1883 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1884 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1885 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1886 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1887 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1888
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001889 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001890
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001891 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1892 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1893 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1894
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001895 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1896 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1897 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1898 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001899
1900 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001901 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1902 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1903 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1904 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1905 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1906 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001907
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001908 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001909
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001910log-send-hostname [<string>]
1911 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1912 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1913 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1914 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1915 the logs.
1916
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001917log-tag <string>
1918 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1919 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1920 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001921 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001922
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001923lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001924 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1925 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1926 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1927 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1928 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1929 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001930 used multiple times.
1931
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001932 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001933 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001934 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001935 other files.
1936
1937 local args = table.pack(...)
1938
1939lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001940 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1941 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1942 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1943 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1944 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1945 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1946 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1947 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1948 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1949 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1950 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1951 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1952 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1953 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1954 times.
1955
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001956 See lua-load for usage of args.
1957
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001958lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1959 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1960 variable.
1961 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1962 to "path".
1963
1964 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1965 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1966 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1967 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1968 will be checked earlier.
1969
1970 As an example by specifying the following path:
1971
1972 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1973 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1974
1975 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1976 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1977 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1978 paths if that does not exist either.
1979
1980 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1981 documentation.
1982
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001983master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001984 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1985 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1986 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001987 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001988 or daemon mode.
1989
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001990 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1991 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1992 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1993 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1994 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001995
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001996 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001997
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001998mworker-max-reloads <number>
1999 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002000 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002001 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
2002 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
2003 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
2004
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002005nbthread <number>
2006 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002007 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
2008 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
2009 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
2010 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
2011 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
2012 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
2013 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002014
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002015no-quic
2016 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
2017 change without deprecation in the future.
2018
2019 Disable QUIC transport protocol. All the QUIC listeners will still be created.
2020 But they will not bind their addresses. Hence, no QUIC traffic will be
2021 processed by haproxy. See also "quic_enabled" sample fetch.
2022
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002023numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01002024 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
2025 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
2026 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
2027 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
2028 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
2029 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
2030 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
2031 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
2032 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
2033 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002034
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002035pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09002036 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
2037 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2038 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2039 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002040
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002041pp2-never-send-local
2042 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2043 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2044 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2045 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2046 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2047 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2048 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2049 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2050 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2051 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2052 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2053
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002054presetenv <name> <value>
2055 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2056 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2057 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2058 and "unsetenv".
2059
2060resetenv [<name> ...]
2061 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2062 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2063 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2064 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2065 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2066 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2067 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2068 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2069
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002070server-state-base <directory>
2071 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002072 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2073 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002074
2075server-state-file <file>
2076 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2077 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2078 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2079 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2080 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2081 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2082 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2083 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002084 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2085 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002086
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002087set-dumpable
2088 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2089 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2090 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2091 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2092 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2093 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2094 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2095 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2096 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2097 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2098 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2099 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2100 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2101 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2102 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2103 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2104 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2105 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2106
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002107set-var <var-name> <expr>
2108 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2109 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2110 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2111 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2112 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2113 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002114 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002115 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2116 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2117
2118 Example:
2119 global
2120 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2121 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2122 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2123
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002124set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2125 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2126 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2127 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2128 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2129 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2130 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2131 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2132 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2133 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2134 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
2135
2136 Example:
2137 global
2138 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2139 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2140
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002141setenv <name> <value>
2142 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2143 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2144 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2145 and "unsetenv".
2146
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002147ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2148 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2149 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002150 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002151 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002152 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2153 information and recommendations see e.g.
2154 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2155 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2156 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2157 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002158
2159ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2160 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2161 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2162 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2163 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2164 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002165 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2166 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2167 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002168 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002169
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002170ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2171 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2172 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2173 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2174 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2175 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2176
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002177ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2178 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2179 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2180 keyword to see available options.
2181
2182 Example:
2183 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002184 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002185
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002186ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2187 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2188 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002189 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002190 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002191 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2192 information and recommendations see e.g.
2193 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2194 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2195 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2196 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2197 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002198
2199ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2200 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2201 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2202 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2203 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2204 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002205 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2206 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2207 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2208 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002209
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002210ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2211 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2212 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2213 keyword to see available options.
2214
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002215ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2216 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2217 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2218 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002219 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002220 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002221 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002222 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2223 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2224 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2225 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002226 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2227 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2228 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2229
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002230ssl-propquery <query>
2231 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2232 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2233 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2234 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2235 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2236 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2237 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2238 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2239 was not found.
2240
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002241ssl-provider <name>
2242 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2243 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2244 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2245 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2246 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2247 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002248
2249 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002250 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2251 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2252 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2253 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2254 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002255
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002256 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2257 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2258 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2259 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002260
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002261 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2262
2263ssl-provider-path <path>
2264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2265 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2266 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2267 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2268 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2269 defined.
2270 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002271
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002272ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2273 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2274 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002275 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002276 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002277 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2278
2279 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002280
2281 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2282 and won't try to remove them.
2283
2284 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2285
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002286ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002287 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002288 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2289 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2290 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002291
2292 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2293 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2294 optimize the startup time.
2295
2296 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2297 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2298 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2299
2300 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002301 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002302
2303 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002304 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2305 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002306
2307 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2308 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2309 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2310 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2311 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002312 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002313
2314 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002315 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002316 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2317 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2318 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2319 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2320 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002321 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002322
2323 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2324
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002325 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002326 a cert bundle.
2327
2328 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2329 separately in several "crt".
2330
2331 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2332 since files are loading separately.
2333
2334 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2335 required to commit them.
2336
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002337 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002338 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002339
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002340 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2341 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2342 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002343
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002344 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2345 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2346 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002347
2348 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002349 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2350 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002351
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002352 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2353 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2354
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002355 The default behavior is "all".
2356
2357 Example:
2358 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2359 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2360 ssl-load-extra-files none
2361
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002362 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2363 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002364
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002365ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2366 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2367 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2368 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2369
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002370ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002371 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002372 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2373 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2374 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2375 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2376 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2377 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002378 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002379
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002380stats maxconn <connections>
2381 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2382 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2383
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002384stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2385 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2386 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2387 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002388 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002389 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002390
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002391 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2392 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2393 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002394
2395stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2396 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2397 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002398 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002399
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002400strict-limits
2401 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2402 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2403 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2404 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2405 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002406
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002407thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2408 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2409 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2410 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2411 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2412 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2413 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2414 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2415 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2416 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2417
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002418thread-groups <number>
2419 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2420 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002421 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2422 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2423 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2424 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2425 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002426
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002427trace <args...>
2428 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2429 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2430 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2431 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2432 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2433 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2434 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2435 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2436 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2437 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2438 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2439 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2440 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2441 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2442 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2443 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2444 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2445
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002446uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002447 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002448 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2449 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2450 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2451
2452ulimit-n <number>
2453 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2454 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002455 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2456 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002457
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002458 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2459 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2460 manually specify this value.
2461
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002462 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2463
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002464unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2465 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2466
2467 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2468 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2469 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2470 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2471 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002472 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002473 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2474 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2475 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2476 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2477
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002478unsetenv [<name> ...]
2479 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2480 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2481 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2482 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2483 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2484 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2485 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002487user <user name>
2488 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2489 See also "uid" and "group".
2490
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002491node <name>
2492 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2493
2494 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2495 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2496 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2497 traffic.
2498
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002499wurfl-cache-size <size>
2500 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2501 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2502 - "0" : no cache is used.
2503 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002504
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002505 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2506 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002507
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002508wurfl-data-file <file path>
2509 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2510 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2511
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002512 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002513 with USE_WURFL=1.
2514
2515wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2516 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2517 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2518 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2519
2520 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2521
2522 Valid WURFL properties are:
2523 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2524
2525 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2526 device.
2527
2528 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2529 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2530
2531 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2532 particular web request.
2533
2534 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2535 used Libwurfl API version.
2536
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002537 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2538 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2539
2540 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2541 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2542
2543 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2544
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002545 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002546 with USE_WURFL=1.
2547
2548wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2549 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2550 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2551
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002552 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002553 with USE_WURFL=1.
2554
2555wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2556 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2557 thus before the chroot.
2558
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002559 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002560 with USE_WURFL=1.
2561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025623.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002563-----------------------
2564
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002565busy-polling
2566 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2567 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2568 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2569 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2570 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2571 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2572 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2573 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2574 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2575 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2576 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2577 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2578 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2579 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2580 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2581 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2582 "poll" pollers.
2583
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002584 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2585 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2586 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2587
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002588max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002589 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002590 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2591 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2592 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2593 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2594 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2595 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2596 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2597
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002598maxcompcpuusage <number>
2599 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2600 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2601 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2602 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2603 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2604 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2605 and from introducing high latencies.
2606
2607maxcomprate <number>
2608 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2609 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2610 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2611 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2612 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2613 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2614 default value.
2615
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002616maxconn <number>
2617 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2618 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2619 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002620 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2621 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2622 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2623 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002624 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2625 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2626 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2627 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2628 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002629 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2630
2631 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002632
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002633maxconnrate <number>
2634 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2635 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2636 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2637 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2638 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2639 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2640 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2641 fairness.
2642
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002643maxpipes <number>
2644 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2645 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2646 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2647 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2648 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2649 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2650
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002651maxsessrate <number>
2652 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2653 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2654 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2655 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2656 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2657 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2658 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2659 fairness.
2660
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002661maxsslconn <number>
2662 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2663 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2664 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2665 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2666 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2667 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2668 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002669 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2670 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2671 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2672 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002673 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002674 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2675 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002676
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002677maxsslrate <number>
2678 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2679 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2680 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2681 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2682 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2683 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2684 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2685 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2686 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2687 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2688
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002689maxzlibmem <number>
2690 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2691 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2692 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002693 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2694 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2695 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2696
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002697no-memory-trimming
2698 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2699 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2700 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2701 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2702 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2703 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2704 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2705 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2706 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2707 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2708 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2709 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2710 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2711 not suffer from such a problem.
2712
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002713noepoll
2714 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2715 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002716 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002717
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002718noevports
2719 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2720 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2721 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2722 also "nopoll".
2723
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002724nogetaddrinfo
2725 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2726 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2727
2728nokqueue
2729 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2730 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2731 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2732
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002733nopoll
2734 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2735 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002736 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002737 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2738 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002739
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002740noreuseport
2741 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2742 command line argument "-dR".
2743
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002744nosplice
2745 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002746 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002747 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002748 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002749 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2750 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2751 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2752 "option splice-response".
2753
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002754profiling.memory { on | off }
2755 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2756 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2757 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2758 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2759 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2760 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2761 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2762 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2763 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2764
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002765profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2766 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2767 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2768 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2769 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002770 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002771 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2772 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2773 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2774 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2775
2776 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2777 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2778 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2779 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2780 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002781 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2782 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2783 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2784 CLI.
2785
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002786spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002787 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2788 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2789 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2790 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2791 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2792 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002793
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002794ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002795 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002796 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002797 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002798 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002799 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2800 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2801 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002802 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2803 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002804 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2805 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2806 openssl configuration file uses:
2807 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2808
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002809ssl-mode-async
2810 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002811 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002812 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2813 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002814 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002815 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002816 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002817
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002818tune.buffers.limit <number>
2819 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2820 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2821 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2822 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2823 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002824 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002825 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2826 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2827 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2828 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2829 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2830 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2831 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2832 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002833 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002834
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002835tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2836 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2837 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2838 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002839 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002840
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002841tune.bufsize <number>
2842 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2843 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2844 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2845 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2846 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2847 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2848 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002849 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2850 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002851 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002852 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002853 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002854 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2855 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002856
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002857tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2858 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2859 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2860 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2861 this value. The default value is 1.
2862
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01002863tune.disable-fast-forward [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2864 Disables the data fast-forwarding. It is a mechanism to optimize the data
2865 forwarding by passing data directly from a side to the other one without
2866 waking the stream up. Thanks to this directive, it is possible to disable
2867 this optimization. Note it also disable any kernel tcp splicing. This command
2868 is not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by
2869 developers along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally
2870 marked as experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must
2871 appear on a line before this directive.
2872
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002873tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002874 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2875 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2876 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
Willy Tarreau0c4348c2023-03-21 09:24:53 +01002877 failures are handled gracefully. When not set, the ratio is 0. However the
2878 command-line "-dMfail" option automatically sets it to 1% failure rate so that
2879 it is not necessary to change the configuration for testing.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002880
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002881tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2882 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2883 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2884 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2885 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2886 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2887
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002888tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2889 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2890 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2891 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2892 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2893 change it.
2894
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002895tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2896 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002897 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002898 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Glenn Strauss0012f892022-06-04 22:11:50 -04002899 The default value is 65536, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002900 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2901 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2902 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2903 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2904
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002905tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2906 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2907 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2908 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2909 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2910 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002911 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002912 recommended not to change this value.
2913
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002914tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002915 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002916 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002917 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002918 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2919 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2920 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2921 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2922
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002923tune.http.cookielen <number>
2924 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2925 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2926 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2927 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2928 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2929 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2930 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2931 to change this value.
2932
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002933tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002934 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2935 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002936 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002937 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002938 configuration directives too.
2939 The default value is 1024.
2940
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002941tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2942 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2943 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2944 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2945 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2946 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2947 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002948 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2949 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2950 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002951
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002952tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2953 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2954 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2955 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2956 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2957 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2958 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002959 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2960 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2961 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2962 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2963 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002964
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002965tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002966 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002967 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2968 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2969 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2970 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002971 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002972 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002973 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002974 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2975
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002976tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2977 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2978 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2979 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2980 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2981 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2982 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2983 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2984 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2985 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2986
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002987tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2988 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002989 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002990 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2991 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002992 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002993 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2994 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2995
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002996tune.lua.maxmem
2997 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2998 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2999 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
3000 memory.
3001
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003002tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
3003 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003004 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3005 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003006 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003007
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003008tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
3009 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
3010 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3011 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003012 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003013
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003014tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
3015 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
3016 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
3017 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
3018 check servers.
3019
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003020tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01003021 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
3022 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01003023 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
3024 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
3025 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
3026 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
3027 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
3028 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
3029 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
3030 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
3031 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003032
3033tune.maxpollevents <number>
3034 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
3035 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
3036 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
3037 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
3038 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
3039
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02003040tune.maxrewrite <number>
3041 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
3042 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
3043 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
3044 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
3045 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
3046 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
3047 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
3048 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
3049 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3050 bufsize.
3051
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003052tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3053 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3054 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3055 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3056 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3057 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3058 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3059 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3060 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3061 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3062 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3063 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3064 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3065 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3066 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3067
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003068tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3069 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3070 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3071 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3072 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3073 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3074 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3075 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3076 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3077 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003078 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3079 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003080 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3081 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3082 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3083 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3084 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3085 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3086 setting this parameter to 0.
3087
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003088tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3089 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3090 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3091 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3092 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3093 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3094 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3095 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3096
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003097tune.pipesize <number>
3098 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3099 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3100 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3101 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3102 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3103 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3104
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003105tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3106 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003107 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003108 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3109 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3110 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3111 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003112 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003113
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003114tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3115 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003116 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003117 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3118 default is 20.
3119
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003120tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003121 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3122 change without deprecation in the future.
3123
3124 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3125 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3126 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3127 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003128 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003129
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003130tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
3131 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3132 change without deprecation in the future.
3133
3134 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3135 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3136 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3137 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3138 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3139 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3140 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3141
3142 The default value is 30000.
3143
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003144tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
3145 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3146 change without deprecation in the future.
3147
3148 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3149 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3150 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3151 requests.
3152
3153 The default value is 100.
3154
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003155tune.quic.max-frame-loss <number>
3156 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3157 change without deprecation in the future.
3158
3159 Sets the limit for which a single QUIC frame can be marked as lost. If
3160 exceeded, the connection is considered as failing and is closed immediately.
3161
3162 The default value is 10.
3163
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003164tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
3165 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3166 change without deprecation in the future.
3167
3168 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003169 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3170 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003171 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3172 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003173 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3174 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003175
3176 The default value is 100.
3177
3178 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3179 information about QUIC retry.
3180
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003181tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
3182 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3183 change without deprecation in the future.
3184
3185 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3186 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3187 own socket.
3188
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003189 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3190 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003191 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. This is also the only way to
Amaury Denoyellee1a0ee32023-02-28 15:11:09 +01003192 ensure soft-stop is conducted properly without data loss for QUIC connections
3193 and cases of transient errors during sendto() operation are handled
3194 efficiently. However, this relies on some advanced features from the UDP
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003195 network stack. If your platform is deemed not compatible, haproxy will
3196 automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003197
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003198 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3199 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3200 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003201 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003202 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003203
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003204tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3205tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3206 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3207 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3208 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003209 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003210 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003211 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3212 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3213
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003214tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003215 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003216 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3217 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3218 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3219 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3220
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003221tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003222 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003223 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3224 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3225 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3226 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3227 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3228 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3229 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003230
3231tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3232 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003233 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003234 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3235 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3236 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3237 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3238 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3239 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3240 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003241
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003242tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3243tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3244 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3245 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3246 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003247 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003248 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003249 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3250 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3251 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3252 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003253 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003254
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003255tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003256 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003257 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3258 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3259 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3260 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3261 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3262 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3263 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3264 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3265 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003266 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3267 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003268
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003269tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3270tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3271 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3272 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3273 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3274 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3275
3276tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3277 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3278 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3279 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3280 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3281 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3282 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3283 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3284 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3285 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3286 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3287 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3288 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3289
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003290tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003291 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003292 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3293 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3294 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3295 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3296 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3297
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003298tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3299 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3300 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3301 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3302 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3303
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003304tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3305 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3306 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3307 performances. This is disabled by default.
3308
3309 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3310 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3311
3312 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3313
3314 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3315
3316 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3317
3318 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3319 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3320 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3321
3322 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3323 converted.
3324
3325 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3326 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3327 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3328 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3329 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3330 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3331 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003332 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3333 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003334
3335 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3336
3337 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3338 only need this line:
3339
3340 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3341
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003342tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3343 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003344 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003345 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3346 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3347 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3348 being used for too long.
3349
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003350tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003351 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3352 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3353 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3354 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3355 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3356 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3357 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3358 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3359 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3360 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3361 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3362 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3363 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003364
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003365tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3366 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3367 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3368 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3369 1000 entries.
3370
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01003371tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay <number>
3372 Sets the maximum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3373 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 3600 (1 hour). It
3374 must be set to a higher value than "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay". See
3375 option "ocsp-update" for more information about the auto update mechanism.
3376
3377tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay <number>
3378 Sets the minimum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3379 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 minutes).
3380 It is particularly useful for OCSP response that do not have explicit
3381 expiration times. It must be set to a lower value than
3382 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay". See option "ocsp-update" for more
3383 information about the auto update mechanism.
3384
3385 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3386 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3387 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3388 1000 entries.
3389
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003390tune.stick-counters <number>
3391 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3392 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02003393 "http-request" rules. The default value is set at build time by the macro
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003394 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3395 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3396 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3397 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3398 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3399 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3400 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3401 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3402 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3403 entirely disable stick-counters).
3404
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003405tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003406tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003407tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3408tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3409tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003410 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3411 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3412 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3413 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3414 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3415 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3416 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3417 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003418
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003419 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3420 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3421 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3422 all available space is consumed.
3423 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3424 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3425 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003426
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003427tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3428 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003429 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003430 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003431 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003432 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3433
3434tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3435 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3436 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003437 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3438 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003439
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034403.3. Debugging
3441--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003442
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003443anonkey <key>
3444 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3445 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3446 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Amaury Denoyelledd3a33f2023-03-03 17:11:10 +01003447 from the CLI command "set anon global-key". See also command line argument
3448 "-dC" in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003449
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003450quick-exit
3451 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3452 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3453 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3454 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3455 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3456 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3457 do so by developers.
3458
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003459quiet
3460 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3461 line argument "-q".
3462
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003463zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003464 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003465 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3466 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3467 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3468 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3469 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3470
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003471
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010034723.4. Userlists
3473--------------
3474It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3475http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3476it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3477
3478userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003479 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003480 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3481
3482group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003483 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003484 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3485 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3486
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003487user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3488 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003489 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3490 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003491 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3492 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3493 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3494 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003495
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003496 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3497 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3498 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3499 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3500 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3501 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3502 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003503 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003504 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003505
3506 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003507 userlist L1
3508 group G1 users tiger,scott
3509 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003510
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003511 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3512 user scott insecure-password elgato
3513 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003514
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003515 userlist L2
3516 group G1
3517 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003518
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003519 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3520 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3521 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003522
3523 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003524
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003525
35263.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003527----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003528It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003529several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003530instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003531values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3532type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3533values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3534active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3535switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3536present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3537watch it.
3538
3539Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3540known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3541the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3542process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3543during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3544tables.
3545
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003546Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3547that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3548each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003549
3550peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003551 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003552 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3553
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003554bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3555 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3556 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3557
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003558disabled
3559 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3560 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3561 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3562
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003563default-bind [param*]
3564 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3565
3566default-server [param*]
3567 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3568
3569 Arguments:
3570 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3571 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003572 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3573 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3574 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3575 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003576
3577 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3578
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003579enabled
3580 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3581 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003582
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003583log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003584 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3585 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3586 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3587 more details.
3588
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003589peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003590 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3591 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003592 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003593 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003594 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3595 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3596 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003597
3598 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3599 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3600
3601 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003602 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3603 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3604 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003605
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003606 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3607 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003608
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003609 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3610 "server" keyword explanation below).
3611
3612server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003613 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003614 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3615 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3616 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3617 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003618
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003619 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3620 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3621 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3622 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3623 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003624
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003625 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003626 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003627 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003628 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3629 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3630 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003631
3632 backend mybackend
3633 mode tcp
3634 balance roundrobin
3635 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3636 stick on src
3637
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003638 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3639 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003640
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003641 Example:
3642 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003643 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3644 default-server ssl verify none
3645 server haproxy1 #local peer
3646 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3647 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003648
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003649shards <shards>
3650
3651 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3652 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3653 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3654 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3655 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003656
3657table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3658 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3659
3660 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3661 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003662 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003663 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3664 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3665 "stick-table" keyword).
3666
3667 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3668 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3669 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3670 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3671 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3672 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3673 of the stick-table name as follows:
3674
3675 peers mypeers
3676 peer A ...
3677 peer B ...
3678 table t1 ...
3679
3680 frontend fe1
3681 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3682
3683 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3684 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3685
3686 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3687 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3688 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3689 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3690 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3691 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3692 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3693
3694 peers mypeers
3695 peer A ...
3696 peer B ...
3697 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3698
3699 backend t1
3700 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3701
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003702 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003703 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3704 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3705
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090037063.6. Mailers
3707------------
3708It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3709If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3710in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3711
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003712mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003713 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3714 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3715
3716mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3717 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3718
3719 Example:
3720 mailers mymailers
3721 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3722 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3723
3724 backend mybackend
3725 mode tcp
3726 balance roundrobin
3727
3728 email-alert mailers mymailers
3729 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3730 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3731
3732 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3733 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3734
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003735timeout mail <time>
3736 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3737 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3738 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3739 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3740
3741 Example:
3742 mailers mymailers
3743 timeout mail 20s
3744 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003745
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020037463.7. Programs
3747-------------
3748In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3749master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3750managed the same way as the workers.
3751
3752During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3753sequence as a worker:
3754
3755 - the master is re-executed
3756 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3757 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3758 instance of the program
3759
3760During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3761
3762program <name>
3763 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3764 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3765 the management guide).
3766
3767command <command> [arguments*]
3768 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3769 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3770 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3771 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3772
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003773user <user name>
3774 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3775 See also "group".
3776
3777group <group name>
3778 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3779 See also "user".
3780
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003781option start-on-reload
3782no option start-on-reload
3783 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3784 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3785 program section.
3786
3787
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010037883.8. HTTP-errors
3789----------------
3790
3791It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3792imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3793several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3794
3795http-errors <name>
3796 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3797 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3798
3799errorfile <code> <file>
3800 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3801
3802 Arguments :
3803 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003804 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003805 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003806
3807 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3808 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3809 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3810 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3811 before any chroot is performed.
3812
3813 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3814
3815 Example:
3816 http-errors website-1
3817 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3818 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3819 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3820
3821 http-errors website-2
3822 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3823 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3824 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3825
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020038263.9. Rings
3827----------
3828
3829It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3830servers or traces.
3831
3832ring <ringname>
3833 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3834
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003835backing-file <path>
3836 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
3837 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
3838 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
3839 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
3840 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
3841 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
3842 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
3843
3844 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
3845 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
3846 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
3847 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02003848 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
3849 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
3850 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
3851 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
3852 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
3853 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
3854 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
3855 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
3856 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
3857 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
3858 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
3859 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003860
3861 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
3862 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
3863 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
3864 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
3865 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
3866 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
3867 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
3868
3869 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
3870 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
3871 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
3872
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003873description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003874 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003875 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3876
3877format <format>
3878 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3879
3880 Arguments:
3881 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3882 one of the following :
3883
3884 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3885 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3886 designed to be used with a local log server.
3887
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003888 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3889 field is stripped. This is the default.
3890 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3891 rfc3164.
3892
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003893 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3894 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3895 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3896 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3897 is the default.
3898
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003899 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003900 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3901
3902 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3903 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3904
3905 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3906 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3907 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3908 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3909 logger consumes.
3910
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003911 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3912 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3913 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3914 with a local log server.
3915
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003916 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3917 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3918 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3919 used with a local log server.
3920
3921maxlen <length>
3922 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3923 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3924 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3925
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003926server <name> <address> [param*]
3927 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3928 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3929 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3930 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3931 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3932 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3933 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3934 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3935 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003936 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3937 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003938
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003939size <size>
3940 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3941 set to BUFSIZE.
3942
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003943timeout connect <timeout>
3944 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3945
3946 Arguments :
3947 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3948 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3949 as explained at the top of this document.
3950
3951timeout server <timeout>
3952 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3953
3954 Arguments :
3955 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3956 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3957 as explained at the top of this document.
3958
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003959 Example:
3960 global
3961 log ring@myring local7
3962
3963 ring myring
3964 description "My local buffer"
3965 format rfc3164
3966 maxlen 1200
3967 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003968 timeout connect 5s
3969 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003970 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003971
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020039723.10. Log forwarding
3973-------------------
3974
3975It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003976HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003977
3978log-forward <name>
3979 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3980
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003981backlog <conns>
3982 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3983 on connections accept.
3984
3985bind <addr> [param*]
3986 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003987 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3988 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3989 syslog protocol over TCP.
3990 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003991 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3992
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003993dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003994 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3995 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3996 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3997 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003998 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003999
4000log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01004001log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004002 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
4003 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
4004 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004005 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004006 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
4007 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
4008 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004009 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004010
4011 Example:
4012 global
4013 log stderr format iso local7
4014
4015 ring myring
4016 description "My local buffer"
4017 format rfc5424
4018 maxlen 1200
4019 size 32764
4020 timeout connect 5s
4021 timeout server 10s
4022 # syslog tcp server
4023 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
4024
4025 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004026 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
4027 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004028 # all messages on stderr
4029 log global
4030 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
4031 log ring@myring local0
4032 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
4033 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
4034 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
4035 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
4036 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004037
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004038maxconn <conns>
4039 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
4040 10 is the default.
4041
4042timeout client <timeout>
4043 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
4044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020040454. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004046----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004047
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004048Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004049 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
4050 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4051 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4052 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004053
4054A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
4055connections.
4056
4057A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
4058to forward incoming connections.
4059
4060A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
4061parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
4062
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004063A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
4064ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
4065sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
4066the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
4067explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
4068from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
4069"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
4070for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
4071to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
4072optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
4073are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
4074any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
4075names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
4076that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
4077duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02004078names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
4079is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
4080implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4081encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4082adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004083
4084Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4085settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4086of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4087profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4088timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4091'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4092case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4093
4094Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4095logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4096proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4097However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4098name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4099
4100Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4101and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004102bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004103protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4104modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4105arbitrary criteria.
4106
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004107In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4108a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004109the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004110
4111 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4112 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4113 between responses and new requests.
4114
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004115 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4116 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4117 client-facing connection remains open.
4118
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004119 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4120 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004121
4122The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4123frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4124following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004125weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004126
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004127 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004128
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004129 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4130 ----+-----+-----+----
4131 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4132 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004133 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4134 ----+-----+-----+----
4135 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004136
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004137It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004138only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4139within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004140as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004141content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004142and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4143possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004144
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004145There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004146first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004147processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004148second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004149protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4150is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4151new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004152to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004153process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4154already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4155HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4156evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4157one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4158
4159There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4160performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4161tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4162preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4163analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4164HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4165header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4166mitigate this drawback.
4167
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004168There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004169method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4170set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4171in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4172is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4173to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4174above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4175to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4176"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4177frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4178frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4179as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4180upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4181on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4182the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4183upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4184frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4185remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004186
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020041874.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4188--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004189
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004190The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4191limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4192they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4193limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004194marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004195option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004196and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4197with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004198specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4199sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4200anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004201
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004202
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004203 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4204------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004205acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004206backlog X X X -
4207balance X - X X
4208bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004209capture cookie - X X -
4210capture request header - X X -
4211capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004212clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4213clitcpka-idle X X X -
4214clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004215compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004216cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004217declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004218default-server X - X X
4219default_backend X X X -
4220description - X X X
4221disabled X X X X
4222dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004223email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004224email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004225email-alert mailers X X X X
4226email-alert myhostname X X X X
4227email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004228enabled X X X X
4229errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004230errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004231errorloc X X X X
4232errorloc302 X X X X
4233-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4234errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004235error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004236force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004237filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004238fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004239hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004240http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004241http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004242http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004243http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004244http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004245http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004246http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004247http-check set-var X - X X
4248http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004249http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004250http-request X (!) X X X
4251http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004252http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONdf238c32023-01-12 15:59:27 +01004253http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004254id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004255ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004256load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004257log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004258log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004259log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004260log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004261max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004262maxconn X X X -
4263mode X X X X
4264monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004265monitor-uri X X X -
4266option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4267option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4268option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4269option allbackups (*) X - X X
4270option checkcache (*) X - X X
4271option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4272option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004273option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004274option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4275option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004276-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4277option forwardfor X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01004278option forwarded (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004279option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4280option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004281option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004282option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004283option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004284option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004285option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004286option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004287option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4288option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4289option httpchk X - X X
4290option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004291option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004292option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004293option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004294option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004295option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004296option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4297option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4298option logasap (*) X X X -
4299option mysql-check X - X X
4300option nolinger (*) X X X X
4301option originalto X X X X
4302option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004303option pgsql-check X - X X
4304option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004305option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004306option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004307option smtpchk X - X X
4308option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4309option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4310option splice-request (*) X X X X
4311option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +01004312option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004313option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4314option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4315-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004316option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004317option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4318option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4319option tcpka X X X X
4320option tcplog X X X X
4321option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004322option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004323external-check command X - X X
4324external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004325persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4326rate-limit sessions X X X -
4327redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004328-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004329retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004330retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004331server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004332server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004333server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004334source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004335srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4336srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4337srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004338stats admin - X X X
4339stats auth X X X X
4340stats enable X X X X
4341stats hide-version X X X X
4342stats http-request - X X X
4343stats realm X X X X
4344stats refresh X X X X
4345stats scope X X X X
4346stats show-desc X X X X
4347stats show-legends X X X X
4348stats show-node X X X X
4349stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004350-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4351stick match - - X X
4352stick on - - X X
4353stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004354stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004355stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004356tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004357tcp-check connect X - X X
4358tcp-check expect X - X X
4359tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004360tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004361tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004362tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004363tcp-check set-var X - X X
4364tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004365tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4366tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4367tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4368tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4369tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4370tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004371timeout check X - X X
4372timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004373timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004374timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004375timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4376timeout http-request X X X X
4377timeout queue X - X X
4378timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004379timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004380timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004381timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004382transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004383unique-id-format X X X -
4384unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004385use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004386use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004387use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004388------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4389 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004390
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004391
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020043924.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4393---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004394
4395This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4396
4397
4398acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4399 Declare or complete an access list.
4400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004401 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4402
4403 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4404 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4405 using it.
4406
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004407 Example:
4408 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4409 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4410 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4411
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004412 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004413
4414
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004415backlog <conns>
4416 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4418 yes | yes | yes | no
4419 Arguments :
4420 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4421 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004422 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004423
4424 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4425 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4426 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4427 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4428 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4429 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4430 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4431 backlog parameter.
4432
4433 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4434 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4435 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4436
4437 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4438
4439
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004440balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004441balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004442 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4444 yes | no | yes | yes
4445 Arguments :
4446 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4447 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4448 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4449 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4450
4451 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4452 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4453 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4454 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004455 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004456 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004457 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4458 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4459 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4460 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4461 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4462 it, so that you don't worry.
4463
4464 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4465 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4466 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4467 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4468 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4469 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4470 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4471 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004472
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004473 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4474 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4475 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4476 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4477 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4478 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4479 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004480 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4481 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4482 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004483
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004484 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004485 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004486 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4487 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004488 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004489 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4490 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4491 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4492 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4493 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004494 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4495 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4496 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4497 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4498 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4499 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004500
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004501 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4502 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4503 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4504 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4505 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4506 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4507 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4508 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4509 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4510 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4511 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4512 changed using "hash-type".
4513
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004514 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4515 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4516 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4517 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4518 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4519 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4520 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4521 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004522 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004523 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004524 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4525 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004526 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004527
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004528 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4529 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4530 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4531 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4532 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4533 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4534 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4535 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4536 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4537 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4538 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4539 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004540
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004541 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004542 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4543 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4544 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4545 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4546 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4547 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4548 URIs start with a leading "/".
4549
4550 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4551 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4552 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4553 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4554
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004555 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4556 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4557 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004558 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4559 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004560
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004561 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004562 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4563
4564 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004565 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4566 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004567 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4568 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4569 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4570 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004571 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004572 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4573 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004574
4575 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4576 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4577 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4578 server will receive the request.
4579
4580 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4581 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4582 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4583 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4584 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004585 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4586 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004587 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4588 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004589
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004590 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4591 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4592 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4593 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4594 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004595
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004596 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004597 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4598 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4599 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4600
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004601 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4602 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004603 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4604 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004605
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004606 random
4607 random(<draws>)
4608 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004609 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4610 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4611 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4612 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004613 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4614 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4615 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4616 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4617 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4618 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4619 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4620 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4621 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4622 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4623 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4624 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4625 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4626 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4627 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4628 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4629 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4630 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4631 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4632 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004633
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004634 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004635 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004636 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4637 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004638 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004639 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4640 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4641 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004642 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004643 used instead.
4644
4645 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4646 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4647 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004648 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004649
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004650 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4651 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004652 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4653 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004654
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004655 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004656 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4657 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004658
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004659 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4660 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4661 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004662
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004663 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004664 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004665 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4666 NTLM relies on.
4667
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004668 Examples :
4669 balance roundrobin
4670 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004671 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004672 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4673 balance hdr(host)
4674 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004675 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4676 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4677 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004678
4679 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4680 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4681
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004682 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004683 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4684 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4685 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004686 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004687
4688 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4689 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4690 defaults to 16 kB.
4691
4692 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4693 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4694
4695 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4696 Round Robin.
4697
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004698 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004699 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4700 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4701 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4702
4703 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4704
4705 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004706 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004707 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4708 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4709 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004710
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004711 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004712
4713
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004714bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4715bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004716 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4718 no | yes | yes | no
4719 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004720 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4721 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4722 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4723 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004724 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
4725 that if you bind a frontend to multiple UDP addresses you have
4726 no guarantee about the address which will be used to respond.
4727 This is why "0.0.0.0" addresses and lists of comma-separated
4728 IP addresses have been forbidden to bind QUIC addresses.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004729 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4730 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4731 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4732 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4733 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4734 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004735 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004736 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4737 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004738 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004739 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4740 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004741 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004742 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4743 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004744 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004745 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004746 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4747 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4748 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004749 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4750 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4751 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4752 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004753 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01004754 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
4755 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.conn-owner" on
4756 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
4757 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
4758 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
4759 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
4760 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004761 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01004762 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
4763 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004764
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004765 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4766 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4767 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004768
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004769 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4770 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004771 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4772 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4773 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004774 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4775 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4776 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4777 the range.
4778
4779 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4780 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4781 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4782 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4783 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4784 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4785 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004786 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004787 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004788
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004789 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004790 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004791 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4792 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4793 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4794 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4795 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4796 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4797
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004798 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4799 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4800 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4801 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004802
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004803 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4804 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4805 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4806 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4807 in a frontend.
4808
4809 Example :
4810 listen http_proxy
4811 bind :80,:443
4812 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004813 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004814
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004815 listen http_https_proxy
4816 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004817 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004818
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004819 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4820 bind ipv6@:80
4821 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4822 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4823
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004824 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004825 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004826
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004827 listen h3_quic_proxy
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004828 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt alpn h3
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004829
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004830 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4831 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4832 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4833 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4834 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4835
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004836 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004837 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004838
4839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004840capture cookie <name> len <length>
4841 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4843 no | yes | yes | no
4844 Arguments :
4845 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4846 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4847 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4848 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004849 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004850
4851 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4852 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4853 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4854 right if it exceeds <length>.
4855
4856 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4857 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4858 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4859 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4860
4861 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4862 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4863 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4864
4865 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4866 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4867 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004868 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4869 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4870 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004871
4872 Example:
4873 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4874
4875 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004876 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004877
4878
4879capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004880 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004881 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4882 no | yes | yes | no
4883 Arguments :
4884 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004885 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004886 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4887 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4888 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4889
4890 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4891 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4892 it exceeds <length>.
4893
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004894 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004895 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4896 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004897 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4898 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4899 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4900 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004901 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004902 environments to find where the request came from.
4903
4904 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4905 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4906 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4907 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004908
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004909 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4910 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4911 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4912 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4913 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004914
4915 Example:
4916 capture request header Host len 15
4917 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004918 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004919
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004920 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004921 about logging.
4922
4923
4924capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004925 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4927 no | yes | yes | no
4928 Arguments :
4929 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004930 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004931 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4932 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4933 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4934
4935 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4936 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4937 it exceeds <length>.
4938
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004939 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004940 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4941 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4942 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004943 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4944 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4945 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4946 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004947
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004948 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4949 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4950 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4951 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4952 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004953
4954 Example:
4955 capture response header Content-length len 9
4956 capture response header Location len 15
4957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004958 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004959 about logging.
4960
4961
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004962clitcpka-cnt <count>
4963 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4964 the connection on the client side.
4965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4966 yes | yes | yes | no
4967 Arguments :
4968 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4969
4970 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4971 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004972 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4973 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004974
4975 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4976
4977
4978clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4979 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4980 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4981 client side.
4982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4983 yes | yes | yes | no
4984 Arguments :
4985 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4986 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4987 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4988 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4989
4990 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4991 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004992 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4993 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004994
4995 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4996
4997
4998clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4999 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
5000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5001 yes | yes | yes | no
5002 Arguments :
5003 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
5004 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
5005 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
5006 document.
5007
5008 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
5009 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005010 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5011 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005012
5013 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
5014
5015
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005016compression algo <algorithm> ...
5017compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005018 Enable HTTP compression.
5019 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5020 yes | yes | yes | yes
5021 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005022 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
5023 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005024
5025 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005026 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
5027 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
5028 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005029
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005030 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005031 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005032
5033 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
5034 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
5035 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
5036 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
5037 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005038 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005039
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005040 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
5041 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
5042 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
5043 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
5044 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
5045 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
5046 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005047 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005048
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04005049 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005050 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005051 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005052 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005053 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005054 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005055 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02005056
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005057 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005058 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
5059 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02005060 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005061 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005062 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
5063 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
5064 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
5065 "multipart"
5066 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
5067 header
5068 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
5069 and later
5070 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
5071 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005072 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005073
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01005074 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005075
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005076 Examples :
5077 compression algo gzip
5078 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005079
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01005080 See also : "compression offload"
5081
5082compression offload
5083 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5085 no | yes | yes | yes
5086
5087 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5088 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5089 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5090 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5091 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5092 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5093 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5094 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5095 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5096 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5097 then be used for such scenarios.
5098
5099 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5100 option is ignored.
5101
5102 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005103
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005104cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005105 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5106 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005107 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005108 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5109 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5110 yes | no | yes | yes
5111 Arguments :
5112 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5113 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5114 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5115 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5116 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5117 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005118 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005119 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5120 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5121
5122 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005123 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005124 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5125 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5126 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5127 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005128 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5129 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005130 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005131 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5132 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005133
5134 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005135 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005136
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005137 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005138 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005139 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005140 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005141 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5142 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5143 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5144 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5145 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5146 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5147 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005148
5149 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5150 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5151 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5152 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5153 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5154 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5155 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5156 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5157 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005158 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005159 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5160 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5161 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005162
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005163 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5164 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5165 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005166 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5167 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5168 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5169 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005170 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5171 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5172 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005173
5174 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5175 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5176 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5177 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5178 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5179 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5180 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5181 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5182 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5183
5184 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5185 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5186 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5187 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5188 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5189 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5190 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5191 persistence cookie in the cache.
5192 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5193
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005194 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5195 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005196 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005197 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5198 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005199 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005200 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5201 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5202 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5203 they logout.
5204
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005205 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005206 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5207 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5208 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5209
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005210 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005211 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5212 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5213 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5214 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5215 this attribute.
5216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005217 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005218 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005219 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5220 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5221 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5222 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5223 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5224 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005225
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005226 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5227 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5228 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5229 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5230 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5231 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5232 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5233 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005234 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005235 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5236 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5237 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5238 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5239 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5240 the site.
5241
5242 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5243 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5244 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5245 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5246 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5247 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5248 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5249 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5250 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5251 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5252 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5253 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5254 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005255 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005256 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5257 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5258
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005259 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5260 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5261 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5262 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5263 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5264 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5265
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005266 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005267 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5268 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5269 repeated.
5270
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005271 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5272 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5273 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5274 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005275
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005276 Examples :
5277 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5278 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5279 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005280 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005281
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005282 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005283
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005284
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005285declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5286 Declares a capture slot.
5287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5288 no | yes | yes | no
5289 Arguments:
5290 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5291
5292 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5293 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5294 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5295 for use in the response.
5296
5297 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005298 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005299 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5300
5301
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005302default-server [param*]
5303 Change default options for a server in a backend
5304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5305 yes | no | yes | yes
5306 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005307 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5308 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5309 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5310 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005311
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005312 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005313 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5314
5315 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005316
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005317
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005318default_backend <backend>
5319 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5321 yes | yes | yes | no
5322 Arguments :
5323 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5324
5325 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5326 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5327 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5328 will catch all undetermined requests.
5329
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005330 Example :
5331
5332 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5333 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5334 default_backend dynamic
5335
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005336 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005337
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005338
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005339description <string>
5340 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5342 no | yes | yes | yes
5343 Arguments : string
5344
5345 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5346 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5347 it describes.
5348 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5349
5350
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005351disabled
5352 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5354 yes | yes | yes | yes
5355 Arguments : none
5356
5357 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5358 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5359 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5360 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5361 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5362 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5363 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5364
5365 See also : "enabled"
5366
5367
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005368dispatch <address>:<port>
5369 Set a default server address
5370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5371 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005372 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005373
5374 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5375 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5376 during start-up.
5377
5378 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5379 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5380 possible with normal servers.
5381
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005382 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005383 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5384 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5385 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5386 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5387
5388 See also : "server"
5389
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005390
5391dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5392 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5394 yes | no | yes | yes
5395 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5396
5397 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005398 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005399 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5400 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005401 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005402 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005403
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005404enabled
5405 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5407 yes | yes | yes | yes
5408 Arguments : none
5409
5410 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5411 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5412
5413 See also : "disabled"
5414
5415
5416errorfile <code> <file>
5417 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5419 yes | yes | yes | yes
5420 Arguments :
5421 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005422 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005423 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005424
5425 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005426 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005427 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005428 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5429 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005430
5431 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5432 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5433 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5434
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005435 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5436
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005437 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5438 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5439 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5440 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5441 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5442 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5443 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5444 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5445 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005446
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005447 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5448 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5449 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005450 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005451 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5452
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005453 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005454
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005455 Example :
5456 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005457 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005458 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5459 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5460
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005461
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005462errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5463 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5464 section.
5465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5466 yes | yes | yes | yes
5467 Arguments :
5468 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5469
5470 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005471 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005472 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5473 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005474
5475 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5476 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5477 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5478 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5479 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005480 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005481 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5482
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005483 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5484 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005485
5486 Example :
5487 errorfiles generic
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01005488 errorfiles site-1 403 404
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005489
5490
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005491errorloc <code> <url>
5492errorloc302 <code> <url>
5493 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5494 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5495 yes | yes | yes | yes
5496 Arguments :
5497 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005498 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005499 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005500
5501 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5502 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5503 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5504 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005505 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005506
5507 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5508 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5509 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5510
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005511 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5512
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005513 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5514 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5515 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5516 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005517 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005518 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5519 request.
5520
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005521 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005522
5523
5524errorloc303 <code> <url>
5525 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5527 yes | yes | yes | yes
5528 Arguments :
5529 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005530 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005531 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005532
5533 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5534 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5535 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5536 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005537 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005538
5539 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5540 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5541 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5542
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005543 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5544
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005545 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5546 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5547 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5548 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005549 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005550
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005551 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005552
5553
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005554email-alert from <emailaddr>
5555 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005556 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005557 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5558 yes | yes | yes | yes
5559
5560 Arguments :
5561
5562 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5563
5564 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5565 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5566
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005567 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005568 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5569 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005570
5571
5572email-alert level <level>
5573 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5574 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5575 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5576 yes | yes | yes | yes
5577
5578 Arguments :
5579
5580 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5581 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5582 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5583
5584 By default level is alert
5585
5586 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5587 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5588 for the proxy.
5589
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005590 Alerts are sent when :
5591
5592 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5593 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5594 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5595 is notice or lower
5596 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5597 and a health check status update occurs
5598
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005599 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5600 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005601 section 3.6 about mailers.
5602
5603
5604email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5605 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5606 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5607 yes | yes | yes | yes
5608
5609 Arguments :
5610
5611 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5612
5613 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5614 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5615
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005616 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5617 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005618
5619
5620email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5621 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5622 mailers.
5623 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 yes | yes | yes | yes
5625
5626 Arguments :
5627
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005628 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005629
5630 By default the systems hostname is used.
5631
5632 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5633 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5634 for the proxy.
5635
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005636 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5637 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005638
5639
5640email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005641 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005642 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5643 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5644 yes | yes | yes | yes
5645
5646 Arguments :
5647
5648 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5649
5650 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5651 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5652
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005653 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005654 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5655
5656
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005657error-log-format <string>
5658 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5659 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5660 yes | yes | yes | no
5661
5662 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5663 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5664 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5665 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005666 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5667
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005668 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5669 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5670 string in depth.
5671
5672 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5673 directives.
5674
5675
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005676force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5677 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5678 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005679 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005680
5681 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5682 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5683 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5684 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5685 marked down for maintenance operations.
5686
5687 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5688 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5689 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5690 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5691 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5692 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5693 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5694 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5695 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5696
5697 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5698 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5699 is used.
5700
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005701 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005702 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005703
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005704
5705filter <name> [param*]
5706 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5708 no | yes | yes | yes
5709 Arguments :
5710 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5711 referenced in section 9.
5712
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005713 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005714 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005715 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5716 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005717
5718 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5719 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5720
5721 Example:
5722 listen
5723 bind *:80
5724
5725 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5726 filter compression
5727 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5728
5729 compression algo gzip
5730 compression offload
5731
5732 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5733
5734 See also : section 9.
5735
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005736
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005737fullconn <conns>
5738 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5740 yes | no | yes | yes
5741 Arguments :
5742 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5743 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5744
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005745 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005746 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005747 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005748 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5749 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5750 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5751 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5752 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005753 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005754
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005755 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005756 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005757 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5758 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5759 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005760
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005761 Example :
5762 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5763 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5764 # connections.
5765 backend dynamic
5766 fullconn 10000
5767 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5768 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5769
5770 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5771
5772
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005773hash-balance-factor <factor>
5774 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5776 yes | no | no | yes
5777 Arguments :
5778 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5779 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005780 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005781
5782 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5783 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5784 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5785 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5786 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5787 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5788 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5789
5790 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5791 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5792 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5793 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5794 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5795
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005796 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5797 consistent hashing mechanism.
5798
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005799 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5800
5801
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005802hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005803 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5805 yes | no | yes | yes
5806 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005807 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5808 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005809
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005810 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5811 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5812 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5813 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5814 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5815 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5816 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5817 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5818 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5819 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005820
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005821 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5822 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5823 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5824 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5825 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5826 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5827 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5828 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5829 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5830 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5831 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5832 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5833 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005834 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5835 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005836
5837 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5838
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005839 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005840 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5841 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5842 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005843 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5844 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5845 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005846
5847 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5848 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005849 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5850 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5851 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5852 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5853
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005854 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005855 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5856 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5857 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5858 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5859 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5860 parameter.
5861
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005862 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5863 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5864 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5865 used on strings.
5866
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005867 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5868
5869 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5870 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5871 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5872 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5873 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5874 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5875 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5876 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5877 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5878 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5879 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5880 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005881
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005882 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5883 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5884 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005885
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005886 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005887
5888
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005889http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5890 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5891 ones).
5892
5893 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005894 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005895
5896 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5897 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5898 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5899 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5900 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5901 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5902
5903 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5904 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5905 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5906
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005907 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5908 supported:
5909 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5910 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005911 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005912 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005913 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005914 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005915 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5916 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01005917 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005918 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
5919 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
5920 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
5921 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5922 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005923 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005924 - set-log-level <level>
5925 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005926 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01005927 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
5928 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005929 - strict-mode { on | off }
5930 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5931
5932 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005933
5934 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5935 instance.
5936
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005937 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5938 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5939 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5940 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5941 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5942 a defaults section defining such rules.
5943
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005944 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5945 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5946 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5947
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005948 Example:
5949 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5950 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5951 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5952
5953http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5954
5955 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005956 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5957 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005958
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01005959http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5960
5961 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5962 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
5963
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005964http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5965
5966 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5967 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5968 complete description.
5969
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005970http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5971
5972 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
5973 del-acl" for a complete description.
5974
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005975http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005976
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005977 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5978 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005979
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005980http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5981
5982 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
5983 del-map" for a complete description.
5984
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005985http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5986 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5987
5988 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5989
5990 Example:
5991 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5992
5993 # applied to:
5994 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5995
5996 # outputs:
5997 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5998
5999 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
6000
6001http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6002 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6003
6004 This works like "http-response replace-value".
6005
6006 Example:
6007 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
6008
6009 # applied to:
6010 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
6011
6012 # outputs:
6013 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
6014
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006015http-after-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6016 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6017
6018 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
6019 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
6020 a complete description.
6021
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006022http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6023http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6024http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6025
6026 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
6027 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
6028 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
6029 description.
6030
6031http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6032 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6033http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6034 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6035
6036 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
6037 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
6038 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
6039
6040http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6041
6042 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
6043 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
6044
6045http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6046
6047 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6048 set-map" for a complete description.
6049
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006050http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6051
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006052 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
6053 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6054 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6055 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006056
6057http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6058 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6059
6060 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05006061 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006062 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006063
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006064http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6065http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006066
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006067 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6068 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
6069 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006070
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006071http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006072
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006073 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
6074 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006075
6076http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6077
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006078 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
6079 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006080
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006081
6082http-check comment <string>
6083 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
6084 it fails.
6085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6086 yes | no | yes | yes
6087
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006088 Arguments :
6089 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6090 rule fails.
6091
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006092 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6093 user-friendly error reporting.
6094
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006095 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006096 "http-check expect".
6097
6098
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006099http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6100 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01006101 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006102 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6104 yes | no | yes | yes
6105
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006106 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006107 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6108
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006109 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006110 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006111
6112 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6113 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6114 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6115 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6116
6117 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6118
6119 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6120
6121 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6122
6123 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6124
6125 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6126
6127 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6128 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6129 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6130 is used.
6131
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006132 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6133 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6134 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6135 haproxy -vv.
6136
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006137 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6138
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006139 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6140 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6141 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6142 different ports or with different servers.
6143
6144 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6145 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6146 the port with a "http-check connect".
6147
6148 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6149 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6150 do.
6151
6152 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6153 unset-var or comment rules.
6154
6155 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006156 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6157 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6158 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6159 option httpchk
6160
6161 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006162 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006163 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006164 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006165 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006166 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006167
6168 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6169
6170 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006171
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006172
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006173http-check disable-on-404
6174 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6175 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006176 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006177 Arguments : none
6178
6179 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6180 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6181 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6182 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6183 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6184 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6185 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6186 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006187 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6188 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006189 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6190 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6191 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006192
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006193 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006194
6195
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006196http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006197 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6198 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6199 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006200 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006202 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006203
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006204 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006205 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6206
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006207 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6208 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6209 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6210 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6211 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6212 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6213 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6214 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6215 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6216 result is always conclusive.
6217
6218 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6219 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6220 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006221 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6222 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006223 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6224 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006225 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6226 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6227 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006228
6229 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6230 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006231 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6232 supported :
6233 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6234 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006235 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6236 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6237 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6238 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6239 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006240
6241 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6242 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006243 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6244 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6245 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6246 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006247 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6248
6249 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6250 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6251 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6252 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6253
6254 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6255 informational message reported in logs if an error
6256 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6257 log-format string.
6258
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006259 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006260 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6261 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006262 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6263 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6264 details on the supported keywords.
6265
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006266 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6267 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6268 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6269 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006270
6271 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6272 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6273 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6274 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6275 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6276
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006277 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6278 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6279 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6280 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6281 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6282 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6283 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006284
6285 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006286 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006287 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6288 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6289 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6290 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6291
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006292 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6293 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006294 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6295 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6296 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6297 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6298 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6299 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6300 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6301 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006302 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6303 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6304 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6305 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6306 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6307 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6308 insensitive on the header names.
6309
6310 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6311 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6312 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6313 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6314 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6315 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006316
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006317 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006318 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006319 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6320 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6321 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6322 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6323 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006324 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006325 trace).
6326
6327 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006328 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006329 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6330 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6331 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6332 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6333 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006334 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006335
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006336 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6337 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6338 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6339 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6340 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6341 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6342
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006343 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006344 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006345 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6346 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6347 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6348 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6349 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6350 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6351
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006352 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6353 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6354 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6355 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6356 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006357
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006358 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6359 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6360
6361 Examples :
6362 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006363 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006364
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006365 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6366 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6367
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006368 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006369 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006370
6371 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006372 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006373
6374 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006375 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006376
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006377 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006378 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006379
6380
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006381http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006382 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6383 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006384 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6385 health checks.
6386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6387 yes | no | yes | yes
6388 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006389 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6390
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006391 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6392 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6393 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6394 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6395 to invent non-standard ones.
6396
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006397 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6398 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6399 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6400 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6401
6402 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6403 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6404 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6405 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006406
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006407 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006408 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006409 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006410 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6411 to add it.
6412
6413 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6414 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6415 to the log-format rules.
6416
6417 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6418 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6419 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006420
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006421 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6422 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6423 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6424 request.
6425
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006426 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6427 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6428 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006429 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6430 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6431 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6432 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006433 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006434
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006435 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006436 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6437 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006438
6439 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6440 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6441 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6442 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6443 configured request authority.
6444
6445 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6446 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006447
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006448 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006449
6450
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006451http-check send-state
6452 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6454 yes | no | yes | yes
6455 Arguments : none
6456
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006457 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006458 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006459 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6460 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6461 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006462
6463 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6464 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6465 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6466 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6467 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006468 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6469 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6470 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6471
6472 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6473 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6474 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6475
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006476 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6477 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6478 checked in multiple backends.
6479
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006480 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006481 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6482
6483 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6484 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6485 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6486 one fails.
6487
6488 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6489 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6490 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6491
6492 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6493 server's queue.
6494
6495 Example of a header received by the application server :
6496 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6497 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6498
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006499 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6500 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006501
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006502
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006503http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6504http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006505 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006506 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6507 yes | no | yes | yes
6508
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006509 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006510 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6511 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6512 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6513 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6514 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6515 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6516 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6517 and '-'.
6518
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006519 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6520 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006521 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006522 conditions.
6523
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006524 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6525
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006526 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6527 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6528
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006529 Examples :
6530 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006531 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006532
6533
6534http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006535 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006536 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6537 yes | no | yes | yes
6538
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006539 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006540 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6541 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6542 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6543 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6544 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6545 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6546 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6547 and '-'.
6548
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006549 Examples :
6550 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006552
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006553http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6554 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6555 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6556 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6557 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6559 yes | yes | yes | yes
6560 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006561 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006562 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006563 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006564 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006565
6566 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6567 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6568 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6569 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6570
6571 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6572 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6573 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6574 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6575
6576 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6577 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6578 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6579 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6580 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6581 chroot is performed.
6582
6583 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6584 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6585 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6586 considered.
6587
6588 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6589 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6590 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6591 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6592 considered as a raw string.
6593
6594 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6595 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6596 "content-type".
6597
6598 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6599 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6600 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6601 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6602 evaluated as a log-format string.
6603
6604 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6605 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6606 argument to "content-type".
6607
6608 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6609 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6610 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6611 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6612
6613 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6614 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6615 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6616 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6617 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6618 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6619 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6620 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6621
6622 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6623 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6624 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6625
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006626 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6627 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6628 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6629 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6630 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6631
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006632 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6633 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6634
6635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006636http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006637 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6638
6639 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006640 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006641
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006642 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6643 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6644 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6645 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6646 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006647
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006648 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6649 supported:
6650 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6651 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6652 - allow
6653 - auth [realm <realm>]
6654 - cache-use <name>
6655 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6656 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6657 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6658 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6659 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6660 - disable-l7-retry
6661 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6662 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6663 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6664 - redirect <rule>
6665 - reject
6666 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6667 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6668 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6669 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6670 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6671 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006672 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006673 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6674 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6675 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6676 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6677 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01006678 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006679 - set-dst <expr>
6680 - set-dst-port <expr>
6681 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6682 - set-log-level <level>
6683 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6684 - set-mark <mark>
6685 - set-method <fmt>
6686 - set-nice <nice>
6687 - set-path <fmt>
6688 - set-pathq <fmt>
6689 - set-priority-class <expr>
6690 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6691 - set-query <fmt>
6692 - set-src <expr>
6693 - set-src-port <expr>
6694 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6695 - set-tos <tos>
6696 - set-uri <fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006697 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6698 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006699 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01006700 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006701 - strict-mode { on | off }
6702 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6703 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6704 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6705 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6706 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6707 - use-service <service-name>
6708 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6709 - wait-for-handshake
6710 - cache-use <name>
6711
6712 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006713
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006714 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006715
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006716 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6717 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6718 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6719 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6720 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6721 a defaults section defining such rules.
6722
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006723 Example:
6724 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6725 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6726 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006727
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006728 http-request allow if nagios
6729 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6730 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6731 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006733 Example:
6734 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6735 acl add path /addacl
6736 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006738 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006740 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6741 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006743 Example:
6744 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6745 acl setmap path /setmap
6746 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006748 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006749
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006750 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6751 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006753 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6754 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006755
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006756http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006757
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006758 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6759 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6760 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6761 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6762 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6763 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6764 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6765 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006766
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006767http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006769 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6770 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6771 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6772 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6773 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6774 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6775 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6776 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006777
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006778http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006779
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006780 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006781 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006782
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006783http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006784
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006785 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6786 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6787 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6788 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6789 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006790
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006791 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6792 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6793 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6794 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6795 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6796 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6797 instead.
6798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006799 Example:
6800 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6801 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006802
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006803http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006804
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006805 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006806
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006807http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6808 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006810 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6811 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6812 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6813 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6814 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6815 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6816 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6817 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6818 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006820 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6821 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6822 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006823 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6824
6825 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6826 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6827 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6828 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006829
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006830http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006832 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6833 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6834 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6835 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6836 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6837 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006838
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006839http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006840
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006841 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6842 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6843 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6844 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6845 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006846
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006847http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006848
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006849 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6850 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6851 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6852 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6853 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6854 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006855
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006856http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6857http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6858 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6859 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6860 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6861 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006862
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006863 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6864 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6865 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006866 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006867 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6868 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6869 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006870 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006871 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006872
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006873http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6874 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6875 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6876 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6877
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006878http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6879 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006880
6881 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6882 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6883 pointed by <resolvers>.
6884 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6885 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6886 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6887 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6888 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6889 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6890 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6891 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6892 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6893 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006894 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6895 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006896
6897 Example:
6898 resolvers mydns
6899 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6900 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6901 timeout retry 1s
6902 hold valid 10s
6903 hold nx 3s
6904 hold other 3s
6905 hold obsolete 0s
6906 accepted_payload_size 8192
6907
6908 frontend fe
6909 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02006910 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006911 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6912
6913 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6914 # which mean DNS resolution error
6915 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6916
6917 default_backend be
6918
6919 backend b_503
6920 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6921 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6922 # 503 error page to end users
6923
6924 backend be
6925 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6926 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6927 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6928 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6929 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6930
6931 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6932 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6933
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006934http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6935
6936 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6937 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6938 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6939 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006940 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6941 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006942
6943 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6944
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006945http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006946http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006947http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006948http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006949http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006950http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006951http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006952http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6953http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006954
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006955 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6956
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006957 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006958 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6959 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6960 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6961 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006962
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006963 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6964 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6965 the supported backend.
6966
6967 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6968 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6969 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6970 number of segments in the path.
6971
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006972 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6973 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6974 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6975 when improperly combined.
6976
6977 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6978 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6979 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6980 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6981 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6982
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006983 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006984
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006985 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6986
6987 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6988 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6989
6990 Example:
6991 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6992
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006993 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6994
6995 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6996 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6997
6998 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6999 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
7000
7001 Example:
7002 - /#foo -> /
7003
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007004 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
7005 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007006
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007007 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7008 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
7009
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02007010 Example:
7011 - /. -> /
7012 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
7013 - /a/./a -> /a/a
7014 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007015
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007016 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
7017 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
7018
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007019 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007020 their preceding segment.
7021
7022 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
7023 normalizer first if this is undesired.
7024
7025 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7026 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007027
7028 Example:
7029 - /foo/../ -> /
7030 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
7031 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
7032 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007033 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007034 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007035 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007036
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007037 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
7038 removed as well:
7039
7040 Example:
7041 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
7042 - /bar/../../ -> /
7043
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007044 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
7045 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007046
7047 Example:
7048 - // -> /
7049 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
7050
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007051 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
7052 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
7053
7054 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
7055 ".", "_", and "~".
7056
7057 Example:
7058 - /%61dmin -> /admin
7059 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
7060 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
7061 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
7062
7063 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7064 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7065
7066 Example:
7067 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
7068 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
7069
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007070 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02007071 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02007072
7073 Example:
7074 - /%6f -> /%6F
7075 - /%zz -> /%zz
7076
7077 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7078 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7079
7080 Example:
7081 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
7082
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007083 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02007084 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
7085 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
7086
7087 Example:
7088 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
7089 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
7090 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007092http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007094 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7095 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7096 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7097 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7098 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007100http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007102 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7103 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7104 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7105 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007107http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7108 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007109
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007110 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007111 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7112 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7113 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7114 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7115 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007116
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007117 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7118 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7119 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7120 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7121 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007122
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007123 Example:
7124 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7125
7126 # applied to:
7127 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7128
7129 # outputs:
7130 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7131
7132 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007133
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007134 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7135
7136 # applied to:
7137 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007138
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007139 # outputs:
7140 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007141
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007142http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7143 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7144
7145 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7146 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007147 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7148 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7149 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007150
7151 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7152 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7153 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7154
7155 Example:
7156 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7157 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7158
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007159 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7160 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7161 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7162 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7163
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007164http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7165 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7166
7167 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7168 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7169 query-string are replaced.
7170
7171 Example:
7172 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7173 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7174
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007175http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7176 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7177
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007178 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7179 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7180 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7181 against.
7182
7183 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7184 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7185 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007186
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007187 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7188 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7189 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7190 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7191 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7192 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7193 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7194 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7195 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007196 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7197 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007198
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007199 Example:
7200 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7201 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007202
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007203 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7204 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007206http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7207 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007208
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007209 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7210 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7211 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7212 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007213
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007214 Example:
7215 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007216
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007217 # applied to:
7218 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007219
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007220 # outputs:
7221 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007222
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007223http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7224 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7225 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01007226 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007227 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7228
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007229 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007230 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7231 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007232 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007233 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007234 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007235 are followed to create the response :
7236
7237 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7238 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7239 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7240 ignored.
7241
7242 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7243 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007244 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007245 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7246 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007247
7248 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7249 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7250 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007251 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007252 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007253
7254 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7255 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7256 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007257 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007258 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007259 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007260
7261 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7262 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7263 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7264 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7265 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7266 as a raw content.
7267
7268 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7269 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7270 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7271 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7272 considered as a raw string.
7273
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007274 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007275 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7276 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7277 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7278
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007279 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7280 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007281 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007282
7283 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7284
7285 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007286 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007287 if { path /ping }
7288
7289 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7290 if { path /favicon.ico }
7291
7292 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7293 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7294 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7295
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007296http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7297 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7298
7299 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7300 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7301 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7302 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7303 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7304 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7305 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7306 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7307 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7308
7309 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7310 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7311 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7312 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7313 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7314 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7315
7316 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7317 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7318 uploaded bytes, etc).
7319
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007320http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7321
7322 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7323 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7324 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7325 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7326 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7327 at this index.
7328 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7329 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7330
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007331http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7332http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007334 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7335 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7336 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007337
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007338http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7339 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7340 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7341 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7342 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7343 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7344 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7345 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7346 at this index.
7347 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7348 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7349
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007350http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7351 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007352
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007353 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7354 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7355 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7356 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007357
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007358http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7359 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7360
7361 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7362 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7363 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7364 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7365 agent name must be used.
7366
7367 Arguments:
7368 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7369
7370 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7371 configuration.
7372
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007373http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
7374 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007375
7376 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7377 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7378 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7379 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7380 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7381 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7382 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7383 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7384
7385 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7386 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7387 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7388
7389 Arguments:
7390 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7391 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7392 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7393 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7394
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007395 <size> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7396 bytes.
7397
7398 <time> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in
7399 milliseconds.
7400
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007401 Example:
7402 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7403 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7404
7405 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7406
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007407http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007409 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7410 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7411 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7412 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7413 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007415 Arguments:
7416 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7417 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007418
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007419 Example:
7420 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7421 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007422
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007423 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7424 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007425
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007426http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007428 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7429 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7430 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007432 Arguments:
7433 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7434 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007436 Example:
7437 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7438 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007439
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007440 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7441 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7442 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007444http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007446 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7447 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7448 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7449 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7450 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007451
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007452 Example:
7453 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7454 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7455 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7456 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7457 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7458 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7459 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7460 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7461 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007462
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007463http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007464
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007465 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7466 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7467 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7468 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7469 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007470
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007471http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7472 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007473
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007474 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7475 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7476 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7477 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7478 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7479 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7480 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7481 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7482 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007483
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007484http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007485
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007486 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7487 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7488 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7489 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7490 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7491 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7492 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007493 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7494 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007496http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007498 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7499 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7500 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007501
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007502http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007504 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7505 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7506 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7507 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7508 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7509 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7510 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7511 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007513http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007514
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007515 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7516 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7517 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7518 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7519 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7520 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007522 Example :
7523 # prepend the host name before the path
7524 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007525
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007526http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7527
7528 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7529 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7530 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7531
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007532http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007534 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7535 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7536 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7537 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7538 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007539
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007540http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007542 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7543 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7544 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7545 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7546 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7547 values have higher priority.
7548 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7549 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7550 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7551 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7552 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007553
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007554http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007556 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7557 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7558 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7559 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7560 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7561 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7562 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007563
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007564 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007565
7566 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007567 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7568 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007570http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7571 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7572 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7573 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007574 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7575 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007576
7577 Arguments :
7578 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7579 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007580
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007581 See also "option forwardfor".
7582
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007583 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007584 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7585 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7586
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007587 # After the masking this will track connections
7588 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7589 http-request track-sc0 src
7590
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007591 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7592 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7593
7594http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7595
7596 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7597 expression.
7598
7599 Arguments:
7600 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7601 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007602
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007603 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007604 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7605 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7606
7607 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7608 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7609 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7610
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007611http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007612 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7613
7614 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7615 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7616 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7617 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7618 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7619
7620 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7621 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7622 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7623 results.
7624
7625 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007626 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7627 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007629http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7630
7631 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7632 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7633 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7634 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7635 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7636 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7637 information from the request.
7638
7639 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7640
7641http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7642
7643 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7644 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01007645 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
7646 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
7647 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
7648 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
7649 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007650 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7651
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01007652http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7653http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007654
7655 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7656 inline.
7657
7658 Arguments:
7659 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7660 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7661 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7662 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7663 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7664 (request and response)
7665 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7666 processing
7667 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7668 processing
7669 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7670 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7671 and '_'.
7672
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007673 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7674 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007675 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007676 conditions.
7677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007678 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7679 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007680
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007681 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7682 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7683
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007684 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007685 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007686 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7687
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007688http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007689
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007690 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
7691 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
7692 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
7693 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
7694 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
7695
7696 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
7697 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
7698 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
7699 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
7700 session tables.
7701
7702 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
7703 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
7704 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
7705 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
7706 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
7707 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
7708 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007709
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007710http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007711
7712 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7713 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7714 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7715 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7716 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007717 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007718 processing.
7719
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007720 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007721 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7722 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7723 rules evaluation.
7724
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007725http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7726http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7727 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7728 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7729 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7730 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007731
7732 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7733 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7734 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007735 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7736 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7737 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7738 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7739 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7740 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007741 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007742 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7743 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7744 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007745 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007746 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7747 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7748 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7749 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7750 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007751
7752http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7753http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7754http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7755
7756 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7757 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01007758 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
7759 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
7760 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
7761 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007762 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7763 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7764 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7765 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7766 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7767 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7768 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7769
7770 Arguments :
7771 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7772 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7773 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7774 select which table entry to update the counters.
7775
7776 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7777 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7778 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7779 that table until the session ends.
7780
7781 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7782 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7783 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7784 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7785 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7786 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7787 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7788 useful information.
7789
7790 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7791 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7792 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7793 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7794 checks that make use of it.
7795
7796http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7797
7798 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007799
7800 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007801 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007802
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007803http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7804
7805 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7806 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7807 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7808 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7809 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7810 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7811
7812 Arguments :
7813 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7814
7815 Example:
7816 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7817
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007818http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7819 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7820
7821 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7822 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7823 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7824 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7825 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7826 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7827 http-buffer-request".
7828
7829 Arguments :
7830
7831 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7832 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7833
7834 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007835 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007836 bytes.
7837
7838 Example:
7839 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7840
7841 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7842
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007843http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007844
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007845 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7846 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7847 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007848
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007849
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007850http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007851 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7852
7853 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007854 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007855
7856 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7857 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7858 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7859 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7860 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7861 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7862
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007863 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7864 supported:
7865 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7866 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7867 - allow
7868 - cache-store <name>
7869 - capture <sample> id <id>
7870 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7871 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7872 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7873 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7874 - redirect <rule>
7875 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7876 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7877 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01007878 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007879 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7880 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7881 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7882 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7883 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7884 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007885 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007886 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7887 - set-log-level <level>
7888 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7889 - set-mark <mark>
7890 - set-nice <nice>
7891 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7892 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01007893 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
7894 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01007895 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007896 - strict-mode { on | off }
7897 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7898 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7899 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7900 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7901 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7902
7903 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007904
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007905 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007906
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007907 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7908 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7909 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7910 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7911 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7912 a defaults section defining such rules.
7913
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007914 Example:
7915 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007917 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007918
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007919 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7920 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007921
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007922 Example:
7923 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007924
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007925 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007926
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007927 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7928 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007930 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7931 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007932
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007933http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007934
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007935 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7936 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007938http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007940 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007941 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7942 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007944http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007946 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7947 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007948
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007949http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007950
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007951 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007952
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007953http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007954
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007955 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7956 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7957 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7958 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7959 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7960 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7961 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007963 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7964 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7965 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7966 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7967 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007968
7969 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7970 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7971 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7972 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007974http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007975
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007976 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7977 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007978
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007979http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007980
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007981 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7982 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007984http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007985
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007986 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7987 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007988
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007989http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7990http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7991 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7992 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7993 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7994 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007995
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007996 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7997 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7998 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007999 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008000 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
8001 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
8002 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01008003 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008004 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008005
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008006http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008007
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008008 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
8009 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
8010 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
8011 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
8012 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
8013 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008015http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8016 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008017
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008018 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
8019 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01008020
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008021 Example:
8022 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02008023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008024 # applied to:
8025 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008027 # outputs:
8028 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008029
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008030 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008031
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008032http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8033 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008034
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01008035 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008036 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008038 Example:
8039 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008041 # applied to:
8042 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008044 # outputs:
8045 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008046
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008047http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
8048 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8049 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01008050 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008051 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8052
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008053 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
8054 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
8055 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008056
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008057http-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8058 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8059
8060 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
8061 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
8062 a complete description.
8063
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02008064http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008065http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8066http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08008067
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008068 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
8069 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
8070 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
8071 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008072
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02008073http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008074 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01008075http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8076 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008077
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008078 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
8079 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
8080 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008081
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02008082http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
8083 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008084
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008085 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
8086 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02008087
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008088http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
8089 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02008090
8091 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
8092 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
8093 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
8094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008095http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008096
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008097 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
8098 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
8099 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
8100 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008102http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8103
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008104 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
8105 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008106
8107http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8108
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008109 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8110 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008111
8112http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8113
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008114 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8115 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8116 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008117
8118http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8119
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008120 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8121 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008122
8123http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8124 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8125
8126 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8127 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8128 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8129 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008130
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008131 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008132 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8133 http-response set-status 431
8134 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8135 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008136
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008137http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008138
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008139 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008140 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8141 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008142
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008143http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8144http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008145
8146 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008147 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8148 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008149
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008150http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008152 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8153 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008154 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8155 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008156
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008157http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008158
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008159 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8160 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008161
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008162http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8163http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8164http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008165
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008166 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8167 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8168 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008169
8170http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8171
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008172 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008173 about <var-name>.
8174
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008175http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8176 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8177
8178 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008179 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8180 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008181
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008182
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008183http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8184 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8185
8186 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8187 yes | no | yes | yes
8188
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008189 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008190 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8191 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8192 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008193
8194 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8195
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008196 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8197 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8198 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8199 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8200 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8201 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8202 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008203 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008204 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8205 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008206
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008207 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8208 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8209 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8210 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8211 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8212 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8213 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008214 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8215 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8216 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8217 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8218 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8219 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008220
8221 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8222 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8223 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8224 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8225 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8226 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8227 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8228 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008229 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008230 downsides of rare connection failures.
8231
8232 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8233 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8234 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8235 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8236 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8237 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008238 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008239 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8240 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8241 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8242 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8243 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8244
8245 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008246 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8247 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8248 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8249 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008250
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008251 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
8252 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008253
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008254 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008255
8256 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8257 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8258 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8259
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008260 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8261 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8262 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8263 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8264 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8265 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8266 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8267 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8268 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8269 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8270 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8271
8272 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8273 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8274 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8275 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8276 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8277
8278 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8279 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008280
8281
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008282http-send-name-header [<header>]
8283 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008284 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8285 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008286 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008287 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8288
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008289 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8290 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8291 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8292 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8293 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8294 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8295 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8296 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8297 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8298 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8299 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8300 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8301 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8302 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8303 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8304 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008305
8306 See also : "server"
8307
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008308id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008309 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8311 no | yes | yes | yes
8312 Arguments : none
8313
8314 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8315 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8316 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008317
8318
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008319ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8320 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8321 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008322 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008323
8324 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8325 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8326 and running).
8327
8328 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8329 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8330 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008331 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008332 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8333
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008334 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8335 "unless" condition is met.
8336
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008337 Example:
8338 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8339 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8340 ignore-persist if url_static
8341
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008342 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8343
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008344load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8345 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8347 yes | no | yes | yes
8348
8349 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8350 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8351 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008352 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008353 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008354 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8355 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8356 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8357
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008358 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008359 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008360 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008361
8362 Arguments:
8363 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8364 named "server-state-file".
8365
8366 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8367 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8368 name is used as a file name.
8369
8370 none don't load any stat for this backend
8371
8372 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008373 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8374 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8375 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008376 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008377 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008378
8379 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8380 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8381
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008382 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008383
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008384 global
8385 stats socket /tmp/socket
8386 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008387
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008388 defaults
8389 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008390
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008391 backend bk
8392 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8393 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008394
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008395
8396 Then one can run :
8397
8398 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8399
8400 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8401
8402 1
8403 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8404 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8405 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8406
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008407 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008408
8409 global
8410 stats socket /tmp/socket
8411 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8412
8413 defaults
8414 load-server-state-from-file local
8415
8416 backend bk
8417 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8418 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8419
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008420
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008421 Then one can run :
8422
8423 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8424
8425 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8426
8427 1
8428 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8429 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8430 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8431
8432 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8433 "show servers state"
8434
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008435
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008436log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008437log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008438 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008439no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008440 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8442 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008443
8444 Prefix :
8445 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8446 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8447 prefix does not allow arguments.
8448
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008449 Arguments :
8450 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8451 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8452 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8453 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8454 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8455 parameter.
8456
8457 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8458 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8459
8460 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8461 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8462 standard syslog port).
8463
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008464 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8465 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8466 standard syslog port).
8467
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008468 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8469 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8470 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008471 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008472
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008473 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8474 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8475 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8476 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8477 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8478 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8479 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8480 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8481 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8482 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8483 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8484 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008485 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008486 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8487 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8488 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008489 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8490 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008491
8492 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8493 and "fd@2", see above.
8494
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008495 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8496 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8497 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8498 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8499 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8500 having the logs instantly available.
8501
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008502 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8503 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8504 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8505
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008506 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8507 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008508
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008509 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8510 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8511 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8512 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8513 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8514 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8515 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8516 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8517 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8518 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008519 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008520
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008521 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8522 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8523 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8524 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8525 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8526
8527 <sample_size>
8528 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8529 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8530 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8531 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8532 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8533
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008534 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8535 one of the following :
8536
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008537 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8538 field is stripped. This is the default.
8539 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8540 rfc3164.
8541
8542 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008543 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8544
8545 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8546 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8547
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008548 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8549 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8550 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8551 designed to be used with a local log server.
8552
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008553 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8554 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8555 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8556 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8557 systemd logger consumes.
8558
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008559 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8560 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8561 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8562 used with a local log server.
8563
8564 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8565 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8566 designed to be used with a local log server.
8567
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008568 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8569 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8570 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8571 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8572
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008573 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8574
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008575 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8576 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8577 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8578
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008579 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8580 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8581 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8582 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008583
8584 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8585 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8586 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008587 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8588 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8589 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8590 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8591 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008592
8593 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8594
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008595 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8596 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8597 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008598
8599 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8600 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8601 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8602 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8603
8604 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8605 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008606
8607 Example :
8608 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008609 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8610 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8611 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008612 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008613 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8614 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008615 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008616
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008617
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008618log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008619 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8620 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8621 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008622
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008623 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8624 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8625 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8626 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8627 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008628 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8629 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008630
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008631 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8632 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008633
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008634log-format-sd <string>
8635 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8636 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8637 yes | yes | yes | no
8638
8639 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8640 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8641 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8642 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8643 which covers the log format string in depth.
8644
8645 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8646 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8647
8648 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8649 log format to "rfc5424".
8650
8651 Example :
8652 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8653
8654
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008655log-tag <string>
8656 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8657 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8658 yes | yes | yes | yes
8659
8660 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8661 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008662 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008663 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8664 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8665 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8666 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8667 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8668 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008669
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008670max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8671 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8672 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8673 yes | no | yes | yes
8674
8675 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8676 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8677 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8678 servers.
8679
8680 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008681 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008682 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8683 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8684 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008685 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008686 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8687 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8688 picking a different server.
8689
8690 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8691 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8692 even if they have to be queued.
8693
8694 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8695 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8696
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008697max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8698 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8699 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8700 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008702maxconn <conns>
8703 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8704 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8705 yes | yes | yes | no
8706 Arguments :
8707 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8708 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8709 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8710 closes.
8711
8712 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008713 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008714 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8715 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008716 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8717 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8718 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8719 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008720
8721 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8722 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8723 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8724
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008725 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8726 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008727
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008728 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8729
8730
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008731mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008732 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8734 yes | yes | yes | yes
8735 Arguments :
8736 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8737 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8738 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8739 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8740
8741 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8742 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8743 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8744 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8745 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8746
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008747 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8748 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8749 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008750
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008751 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008752 defaults http_instances
8753 mode http
8754
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008755
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008756monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008757 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8759 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008760 Arguments :
8761 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8762 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008763 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008764 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8765 backend and its backup.
8766
8767 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8768 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8769 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8770 servers in a list of backends.
8771
8772 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8773 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8774 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008775 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008776 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8777 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008778 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008779 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8780 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008781
8782 Example:
8783 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008784 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008785 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8786 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8787 monitor-uri /site_alive
8788 monitor fail if site_dead
8789
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008790 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008791
8792
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008793monitor-uri <uri>
8794 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8796 yes | yes | yes | no
8797 Arguments :
8798 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8799 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8800
8801 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8802 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8803 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8804 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8805 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8806 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8807 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8808 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8809
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008810 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008811 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8812 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008813 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8814 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8815 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008816 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8817 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8818 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008819
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008820 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8821 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8822 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8823 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8824
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008825 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008826 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008827 frontend www
8828 mode http
8829 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8830
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008831 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008833
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008834option abortonclose
8835no option abortonclose
8836 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8838 yes | no | yes | yes
8839 Arguments : none
8840
8841 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8842 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8843 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8844 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008845 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008846 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8847 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8848 encountered while delivering the response.
8849
8850 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8851 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8852 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8853 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8854 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8855 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008856 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008857 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008858 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008859 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8860 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8861 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8862
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008863 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8864 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008865 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8866 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8867 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8868 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8869 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8870 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008871 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008872
8873 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8874 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8875
8876 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8877
8878
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008879option accept-invalid-http-request
8880no option accept-invalid-http-request
8881 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8883 yes | yes | yes | no
8884 Arguments : none
8885
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008886 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008887 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008888 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008889 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8890 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8891 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8892 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8893 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008894 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8895 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8896 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8897 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008898 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008899 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008900 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02008901 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
8902 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008903
8904 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8905 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8906 been confirmed.
8907
8908 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8909 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008910 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8911 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008912 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8913
8914 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8915 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8916
8917 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8918 stats socket.
8919
8920
8921option accept-invalid-http-response
8922no option accept-invalid-http-response
8923 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8925 yes | no | yes | yes
8926 Arguments : none
8927
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008928 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008929 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008930 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008931 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8932 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8933 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8934 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8935 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008936 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8937 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8938 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008939
8940 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8941 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8942 been confirmed.
8943
8944 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8945 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8946 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8947 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8948
8949 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8950 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8951
8952 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8953 stats socket.
8954
8955
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008956option allbackups
8957no option allbackups
8958 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8960 yes | no | yes | yes
8961 Arguments : none
8962
8963 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8964 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8965 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8966 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8967 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8968 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8969 order between the backup servers anymore.
8970
8971 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8972 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8973
8974 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8975 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8976
8977
8978option checkcache
8979no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008980 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8982 yes | no | yes | yes
8983 Arguments : none
8984
8985 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8986 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008987 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008988 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8989 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008990 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008991
8992 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008993 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008994 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008995 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8996 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008997 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008998 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008999 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
9000 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009001 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01009002 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
9003 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009004 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009005 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
9006 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
9007 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
9008 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
9009 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
9010 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
9011 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
9012 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
9013 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
9014
9015 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009016 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
9017 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
9018 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
9019 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009020
9021 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
9022 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009023 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009024 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009025
9026 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9027 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9028
9029
9030option clitcpka
9031no option clitcpka
9032 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
9033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9034 yes | yes | yes | no
9035 Arguments : none
9036
9037 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9038 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009039 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009040 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9041
9042 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9043 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9044 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9045 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9046
9047 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9048 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9049 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9050 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9051 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9052
9053 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9054
9055 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9056 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9057 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
9058
9059 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9060 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9061
9062 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
9063
9064
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009065option contstats
9066 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
9067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9068 yes | yes | yes | no
9069 Arguments : none
9070
9071 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
9072 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
9073 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009074 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01009075 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
9076 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
9077 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
9078 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
9079 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009080
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009081option disable-h2-upgrade
9082no option disable-h2-upgrade
9083 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
9084 connection.
9085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9086 yes | yes | yes | no
9087 Arguments : none
9088
9089 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
9090 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
9091 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
9092 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01009093 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
9094 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
9095 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
9096 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
9097 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
9098 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009099
9100 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9101 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009102
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009103option dontlog-normal
9104no option dontlog-normal
9105 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
9106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9107 yes | yes | yes | no
9108 Arguments : none
9109
9110 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9111 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9112 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9113 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9114 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9115 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9116 logged.
9117
9118 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9119 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9120 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009122 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009123 logging.
9124
9125
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009126option dontlognull
9127no option dontlognull
9128 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9130 yes | yes | yes | no
9131 Arguments : none
9132
9133 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9134 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9135 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9136 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9137 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9138 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009139 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9140 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9141 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009142
9143 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009144 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009145 would not be logged.
9146
9147 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9148 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9149
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009150 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009151 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009152
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009153option forwarded [ proto ]
9154 [ host | host-expr <host_expr> ]
9155 [ by | by-expr <by_expr> ] [ by_port | by_port-expr <by_port_expr>]
9156 [ for | for-expr <for_expr> ] [ for_port | for_port-expr <for_port_expr>]
9157no option forwarded
9158 Enable insertion of the rfc 7239 forwarded header in requests sent to servers
9159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9160 yes | no | yes | yes
9161 Arguments :
9162 <host_expr> optional argument to specify a custom sample expression
9163 those result will be used as 'host' parameter value
9164
9165 <by_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9166 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodename value
9167
9168 <for_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9169 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodename value
9170
9171 <by_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9172 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodeport value
9173
9174 <for_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9175 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodeport value
9176
9177
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009178 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, servers are losing some request
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009179 context (request origin: client ip address, protocol used...)
9180
9181 A common way to address this limitation is to use the well known
9182 x-forward-for and x-forward-* friends to expose some of this context to the
9183 underlying servers/applications.
9184 While this use to work and is widely deployed, it is not officially supported
9185 by the IETF and can be the root of some interoperability as well as security
9186 issues.
9187
9188 To solve this, a new HTTP extension has been described by the IETF:
9189 forwarded header (RFC7239).
9190 More information here: https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html
9191
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009192 The use of this single header allow to convey numerous details
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009193 within the same header, and most importantly, fixes the proxy chaining
9194 issue. (the rfc allows for multiple chained proxies to append their own
9195 values to an already existing header).
9196
9197 This option may be specified in defaults, listen or backend section, but it
9198 will be ignored for frontend sections.
9199
9200 Setting option forwarded without arguments results in using default implicit
9201 behavior.
9202 Default behavior enables proto parameter and injects original client ip.
9203
9204 The equivalent explicit/manual configuration would be:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01009205 option forwarded proto for
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009206
9207 The keyword 'by' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9208 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9209 'by' value will be set to proxy ip (destination address)
9210 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'by' will be set to
9211 "unknown".
9212
9213 The keyword 'by-expr' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9214 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9215 'by' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9216 <by_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9217
9218 The keyword 'for' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9219 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9220 'for' value will be set to client ip (source address)
9221 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'for' will be set to
9222 "unknown".
9223
9224 The keyword 'for-expr' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9225 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9226 'for' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9227 <for_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9228
9229 The keyword 'by_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9230 'by' parameter. 'by_port' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9231 it will be ignored.
9232 "nodeport" will be set to proxy (destination) port if available,
9233 otherwise it will be ignored.
9234
9235 The keyword 'by_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9236 'by' parameter. 'by_port-expr' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9237 it will be ignored.
9238 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9239 <by_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9240
9241 The keyword 'for_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9242 'for' parameter. 'for_port' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9243 it will be ignored.
9244 "nodeport" will be set to client (source) port if available,
9245 otherwise it will be ignored.
9246
9247 The keyword 'for_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9248 'for' parameter. 'for_port-expr' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9249 it will be ignored.
9250 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9251 <for_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9252
9253 Examples :
9254 # Those servers want the ip address and protocol of the client request
9255 # Resulting header would look like this:
9256 # forwarded: proto=http;for=127.0.0.1
9257 backend www_default
9258 mode http
9259 option forwarded
9260 #equivalent to: option forwarded proto for
9261
9262 # Those servers want the requested host and hashed client ip address
9263 # as well as client source port (you should use seed for xxh32 if ensuring
9264 # ip privacy is a concern)
9265 # Resulting header would look like this:
9266 # forwarded: host="haproxy.org";for="_000000007F2F367E:60138"
9267 backend www_host
9268 mode http
9269 option forwarded host for-expr src,xxh32,hex for_port
9270
9271 # Those servers want custom data in host, for and by parameters
9272 # Resulting header would look like this:
9273 # forwarded: host="host.com";by=_haproxy;for="[::1]:10"
9274 backend www_custom
9275 mode http
9276 option forwarded host-expr str(host.com) by-expr str(_haproxy) for for_port-expr int(10)
9277
9278 # Those servers want random 'for' obfuscated identifiers for request
9279 # tracing purposes while protecting sensitive IP information
9280 # Resulting header would look like this:
9281 # forwarded: for=_000000002B1F4D63
9282 backend www_for_hide
9283 mode http
9284 option forwarded for-expr rand,hex
9285
9286 See also : "option forwardfor", "option originalto"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009287
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009288option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009289 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9291 yes | yes | yes | yes
9292 Arguments :
9293 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9294 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009295 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009296 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009297
9298 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9299 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9300 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9301 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9302 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9303 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9304 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009305 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9306 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9307 possible that the client has already brought one.
9308
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009309 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009310 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009311 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009312 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009313 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009314 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009315
9316 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9317 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9318 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9319 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9320 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9321 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009322 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009323
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009324 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9325 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009326 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009327 are under the control of the end-user.
9328
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009329 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009330 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9331 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009332 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9333 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9334 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009335
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009336 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009337 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9338 frontend www
9339 mode http
9340 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9341
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009342 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9343 backend www
9344 mode http
9345 option forwardfor header X-Client
9346
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009347 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009348 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009349
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009350
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009351option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9352no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9353 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9355 yes | yes | yes | no
9356 Arguments : none
9357
9358 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9359 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9360 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9361 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9362 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9363 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9364 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9365
9366 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9367 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9368 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9369 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9370 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9371 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9372 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9373 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9374 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9375 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9376
9377 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9378
9379 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9380 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9381
9382 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9383 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9384
9385
9386option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9387no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9388 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9390 yes | no | yes | yes
9391 Arguments : none
9392
9393 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9394 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9395 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9396 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9397 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9398 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9399 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9400
9401 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9402 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9403 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9404 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9405 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9406 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9407 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9408 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9409 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9410 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9411
9412 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9413
9414 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9415 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9416
9417 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9418 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9419
9420
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009421option http-buffer-request
9422no option http-buffer-request
9423 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9425 yes | yes | yes | yes
9426 Arguments : none
9427
9428 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9429 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9430 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9431 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9432 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9433 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009434 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9435 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9436 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9437 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009438
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009439 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9440 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009441
9442
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009443option http-ignore-probes
9444no option http-ignore-probes
9445 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9447 yes | yes | yes | no
9448 Arguments : none
9449
9450 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9451 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9452 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9453 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9454 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9455 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9456 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9457 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9458 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009459 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9460 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009461 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9462
9463 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9464 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9465 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9466 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9467 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9468 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9469 are often the only way to detect them.
9470
9471 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9472 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9473
9474 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9475
9476
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009477option http-keep-alive
9478no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009479 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
9480 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9482 yes | yes | yes | yes
9483 Arguments : none
9484
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009485 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009486 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9487 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9488 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9489 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
9490 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009491
9492 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9493 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009494 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9495 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9496 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9497 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9498 situations where this option may be useful :
9499
9500 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009501 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009502
9503 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9504 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9505
9506 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009507
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009508 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9509 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9510 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9511 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9512 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9513 not set.
9514
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009515 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009516 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009517
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009518 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009519 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009520
9521
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009522option http-no-delay
9523no option http-no-delay
9524 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9526 yes | yes | yes | yes
9527 Arguments : none
9528
9529 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9530 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9531 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9532 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9533 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9534 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9535 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009536 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009537 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9538 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9539 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9540 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9541 affected.
9542
9543 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9544 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9545 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9546 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9547 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9548 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9549 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9550 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9551 latency environments.
9552
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009553 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9554
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009555
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009556option http-pretend-keepalive
9557no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009558 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
9559 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009561 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009562 Arguments : none
9563
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009564 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009565 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
9566 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
9567 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
9568 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
9569 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
9570 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009571
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009572 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009573 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009574 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009575 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009576 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009577 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9578
9579 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9580 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9581 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9582 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009583 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9584 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009585 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9586
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009587 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9588 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9589 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009590 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009591
9592 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9593 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9594
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009595 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009596 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009597
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02009598option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
9599 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
9600 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
9601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9602 yes | yes | yes | yes
9603 Arguments :
9604 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9605 with no FastCGI application configured.
9606
9607 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9608 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9609 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9610
9611 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9612 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9613
9614 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9615 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9616 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9617 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9618 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9619 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9620 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9621 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9622
9623 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9624 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009625
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009626option http-server-close
9627no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009628 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9630 yes | yes | yes | yes
9631 Arguments : none
9632
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009633 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009634 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9635 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9636 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9637 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
9638 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
9639 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
9640 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
9641 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
9642 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
9643 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
9644 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
9645 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
9646 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009647
9648 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9649 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9650 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9651 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009652 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9653 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009654
9655 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9656 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009657 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9658 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9659 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009660
9661 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9662 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9663
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009664 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
9665 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009666
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009667option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009668no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009669 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9671 yes | yes | yes | no
9672 Arguments : none
9673
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00009674 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009675 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
9676 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
9677 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
9678 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
9679 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009680 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009681
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009682 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009683 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009684 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
9685 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
9686 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009687
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01009688 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
9689 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
9690 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
9691 front of an existing proxy.
9692
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009693 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
9694
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009695 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009696
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009697option httpchk
9698option httpchk <uri>
9699option httpchk <method> <uri>
9700option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009701 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9703 yes | no | yes | yes
9704 Arguments :
9705 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
9706 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
9707 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
9708 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
9709 ones.
9710
9711 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
9712 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
9713 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
9714
9715 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
9716 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
9717 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009718 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009719
9720 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
9721 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
9722 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
9723 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
9724 the lack of any response.
9725
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009726 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
9727 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
9728 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
9729 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
9730
9731 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
9732 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
9733 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009734
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009735 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
9736 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009737 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04009738 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009739 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009740
9741 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009742 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
9743 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
9744 backend https_relay
9745 mode tcp
9746 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
9747 http-check send hdr Host www
9748 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009749
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009750 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
9751 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
9752 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009753
9754
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009755option httpclose
9756no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009757 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9759 yes | yes | yes | yes
9760 Arguments : none
9761
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009762 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009763 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9764 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9765 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9766 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009767
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009768 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
Christopher Fauletd17dd842023-02-20 17:30:06 +01009769 connection, depending where the option is set. The frontend is considered for
9770 client connections while the backend is considered for server ones. If the
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009771 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
9772 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
9773 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009774
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009775 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009776 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
9777 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009778
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009779 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009780 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009781
9782 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9783 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9784
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009785 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009786
9787
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009788option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009789 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009791 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009792 Arguments :
9793 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9794 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9795 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009796 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009797 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009798
9799 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9800 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9801 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9802 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9803 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9804 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9805 ports.
9806
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009807 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9808 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009809
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009810 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009812 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009813
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009814option httpslog
9815 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9817 yes | yes | yes | no
9818
9819 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9820 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9821 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9822 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9823 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9824 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9825 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9826
9827 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9828
9829 See also : section 8 about logging.
9830
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009831
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009832option independent-streams
9833no option independent-streams
9834 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9836 yes | yes | yes | yes
9837 Arguments : none
9838
9839 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9840 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9841 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9842 receive data or not.
9843
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009844 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009845 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9846 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9847 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9848 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9849 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9850 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9851 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9852 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9853 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9854 socket buffers.
9855
9856 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9857 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9858 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9859 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9860 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9861
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009862 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009863
9864
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009865option ldap-check
9866 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9868 yes | no | yes | yes
9869 Arguments : none
9870
9871 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9872 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9873 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9874 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9875
9876 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9877 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9878
9879 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9880 configure it.
9881
9882 Example :
9883 option ldap-check
9884
9885 See also : "option httpchk"
9886
9887
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009888option external-check
9889 Use external processes for server health checks
9890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9891 yes | no | yes | yes
9892
9893 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9894 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9895 command".
9896
9897 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9898
9899 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9900
9901
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009902option idle-close-on-response
9903no option idle-close-on-response
9904 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9906 yes | yes | yes | no
9907 Arguments : none
9908
9909 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9910 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9911 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9912 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9913 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9914 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9915 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9916 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9917 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9918
9919 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9920 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9921
9922 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9923 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9924 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9925 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9926
9927 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9928 "hard-stop-after"
9929
9930
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009931option log-health-checks
9932no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009933 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9935 yes | no | yes | yes
9936 Arguments : none
9937
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009938 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9939 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9940 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009941
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009942 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9943 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9944 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9945 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9946 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9947
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009948 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009949 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009950
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009951 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9952 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9953 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009954
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009955
9956option log-separate-errors
9957no option log-separate-errors
9958 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9960 yes | yes | yes | no
9961 Arguments : none
9962
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009963 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009964 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9965 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9966 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9967 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9968 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9969 provides very important information.
9970
9971 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9972 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9973 error logs.
9974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009975 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009976 logging.
9977
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009978
9979option logasap
9980no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009981 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009982 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9983 yes | yes | yes | no
9984 Arguments : none
9985
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009986 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9987 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9988 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9989 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9990
9991 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9992 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9993 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9994 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9995 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009996 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009997 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9998 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9999 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
10000 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010001 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010002
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010003 Examples :
10004 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
10005 mode http
10006 option httplog
10007 option logasap
10008 log 192.168.2.200 local3
10009
10010 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10011 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10012 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
10013 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010015 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010016 logging.
10017
10018
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010019option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010020 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10022 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010023 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010024 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
10025 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010026 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
10027 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010028
10029 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
10030 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010031 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010032 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010033 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
10034 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
10035 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010036
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010037 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
10038 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
10039 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010040
10041 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010042 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010043 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
10044 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
10045 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
10046 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
10047 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
10048 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
10049 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
10050
10051 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
10052 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010053
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +020010054 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010055
10056 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
10057 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
10058 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10059 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010060 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010061 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010062
10063 See also: "option httpchk"
10064
10065
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010066option nolinger
10067no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010068 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010069 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10070 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010071 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010072
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010073 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010074 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
10075 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
10076 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
10077 connections.
10078
10079 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
10080 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010081 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
10082 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
10083 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
10084 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
10085 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
10086 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
10087 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
10088 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
10089 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
10090 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
10091 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
10092 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
10093 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010094
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010095 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
10096 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
10097 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
10098 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
10099 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010100
10101 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
10102 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010103 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050010104 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010105 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010106
10107 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10108 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10109
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010110 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
10111 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010112
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010113option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
10114 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
10115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10116 yes | yes | yes | yes
10117 Arguments :
10118 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
10119 matching <network>
10120 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
10121 header name.
10122
10123 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
10124 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
10125 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
10126 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
10127 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
10128 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
10129 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
10130 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
10131 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
10132 possible that the client has already brought one.
10133
10134 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
10135 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
10136 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
10137 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
10138 header and requires different one.
10139
10140 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
10141 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
10142 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +010010143 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
10144 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
10145 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
10146 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
10147 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010148
10149 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
10150 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
10151 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
10152 both are defined.
10153
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010154 Examples :
10155 # Original Destination address
10156 frontend www
10157 mode http
10158 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
10159
10160 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
10161 backend www
10162 mode http
10163 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
10164
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010165 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010166
10167
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010168option persist
10169no option persist
10170 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
10171 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10172 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010173 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010174
10175 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
10176 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
10177 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
10178 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
10179 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
10180 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
10181 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
10182 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
10183 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
10184 redirected to another valid server.
10185
10186 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10187 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10188
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +010010189 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010190
10191
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +020010192option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +010010193 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
10194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10195 yes | no | yes | yes
10196 Arguments :
10197 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
10198 PostgreSQL server.
10199
10200 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
10201 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
10202 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
10203 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
10204
10205 See also: "option httpchk"
10206
10207
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010208option prefer-last-server
10209no option prefer-last-server
10210 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
10211 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10212 yes | no | yes | yes
10213 Arguments : none
10214
10215 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010216 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010217 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
10218 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010219 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010220 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010221 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010222 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
10223 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010224 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010225 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010226 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10227 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10228 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010229 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10230 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10231 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010232
10233 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10234 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10235
10236 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10237
10238
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010239option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010240option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010241no option redispatch
10242 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10244 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010245 Arguments :
10246 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10247 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10248 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010249 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010250 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010251 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010252 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10253 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10254 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010256
10257 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10258 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10259 be able to access the service anymore.
10260
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010261 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10262 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010263
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010264 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10265 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10266 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10267 following order:
10268
10269 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10270
10271 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10272 list, or
10273
10274 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10275
10276 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10277 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10278
10279 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10280 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10281 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10282 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10283
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010284 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010285 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10286 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10290
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010291 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010292
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010293
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010294option redis-check
10295 Use redis health checks for server testing
10296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10297 yes | no | yes | yes
10298 Arguments : none
10299
10300 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10301 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10302 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10303 find the "+PONG" response message.
10304
10305 Example :
10306 option redis-check
10307
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010308 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010309
10310
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010311option smtpchk
10312option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10313 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10315 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010316 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010317 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010318 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010319 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10320
10321 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10322 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10323 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10324
10325 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10326 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10327 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10328 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10329 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10330 dead server.
10331
10332 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10333 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010334 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010335 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10336
10337 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10338 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10339 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10340 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010341 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010342
10343 Example :
10344 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10345
10346 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10347
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010348
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010349option socket-stats
10350no option socket-stats
10351
10352 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10354 yes | yes | yes | no
10355
10356 Arguments : none
10357
10358
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010359option splice-auto
10360no option splice-auto
10361 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10363 yes | yes | yes | yes
10364 Arguments : none
10365
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010366 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010367 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010368 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010369 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010370 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010371 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10372 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10373 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10374 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10375
10376 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10377 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10378 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10379 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10380 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10381 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10382 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10383 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10384 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10385 keyword.
10386
10387 Example :
10388 option splice-auto
10389
10390 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10391 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10392
10393 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10394 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10395
10396
10397option splice-request
10398no option splice-request
10399 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10401 yes | yes | yes | yes
10402 Arguments : none
10403
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010404 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010405 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010406 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10407 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10408 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10409 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10410
10411 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10412
10413 Example :
10414 option splice-request
10415
10416 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10417 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10418
10419 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10420 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10421
10422
10423option splice-response
10424no option splice-response
10425 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10426 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10427 yes | yes | yes | yes
10428 Arguments : none
10429
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010430 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010431 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010432 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10433 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10434 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10435 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10436
10437 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10438
10439 Example :
10440 option splice-response
10441
10442 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10443 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10444
10445 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10446 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10447
10448
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010449option spop-check
10450 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +010010452 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010453 Arguments : none
10454
10455 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10456 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10457 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10458 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10459
10460 Example :
10461 option spop-check
10462
10463 See also : "option httpchk"
10464
10465
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010466option srvtcpka
10467no option srvtcpka
10468 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10470 yes | no | yes | yes
10471 Arguments : none
10472
10473 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10474 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010475 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010476 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10477
10478 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10479 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10480 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10481 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10482
10483 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10484 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10485 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10486 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10487 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10488
10489 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10490
10491 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10492 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10493 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10494
10495 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10496 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10497
10498 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10499
10500
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010501option ssl-hello-chk
10502 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10504 yes | no | yes | yes
10505 Arguments : none
10506
10507 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10508 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10509 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10510 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10511 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10512 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10513 hello message.
10514
10515 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10516 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10517 messages, which is appreciable.
10518
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010519 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010520 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10521 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010522
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010523 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10524
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010525
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010526option tcp-check
10527 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10528 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10529 yes | no | yes | yes
10530
10531 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10532 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10533
10534 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10535 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10536 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10537
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010538 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010539 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10540 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10541 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10542 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10543 only.
10544
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010545 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010546 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010547 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10548 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10549 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10550
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010551 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010552 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10553 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010554 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010555 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10556 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10557 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10558 the respective protocols.
10559 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010560 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010561
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010562 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010563
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010564 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10565 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10566 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10567 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010568
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010569 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10570 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10571 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010572
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010573
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010574 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010575 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010576 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010577 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010578
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010579 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010580 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010581 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010582
10583 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10584 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010585 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010586 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010587 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010588 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010589 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010590 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010591 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10592 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010593 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010594 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10595 tcp-check expect string +OK
10596
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010597 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010598 (send many headers before analyzing)
10599 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010600 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010601 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10602 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10603 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10604 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010605 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010606
10607
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010608 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010609
10610
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010611option tcp-smart-accept
10612no option tcp-smart-accept
10613 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10615 yes | yes | yes | no
10616 Arguments : none
10617
10618 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10619 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10620 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10621 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10622 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10623 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10624
10625 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
10626 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
10627 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
10628 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
10629
10630 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
10631 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
10632 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010633 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010634
10635 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
10636 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
10637 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
10638
10639 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10640 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10641 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10642
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010643 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10644
10645
10646option tcp-smart-connect
10647no option tcp-smart-connect
10648 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10650 yes | no | yes | yes
10651 Arguments : none
10652
10653 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10654 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10655 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10656 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10657 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10658
10659 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10660 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10661 complex.
10662
10663 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10664 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10665 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10666
10667 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10668 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10669
10670 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
10671
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010672
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010673option tcpka
10674 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
10675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10676 yes | yes | yes | yes
10677 Arguments : none
10678
10679 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10680 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010681 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010682 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10683
10684 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10685 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10686 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10687 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10688
10689 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10690 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10691 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10692 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10693 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10694
10695 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10696
10697 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
10698 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
10699 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
10700 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
10701 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
10702 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
10703 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
10704 backends.
10705
10706 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
10707
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010708
10709option tcplog
10710 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
10711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010712 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010713 Arguments : none
10714
10715 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10716 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10717 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
10718 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
10719 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
10720 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
10721 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
10722 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
10723
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010724 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10725
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010726 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010727
10728
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010729option transparent
10730no option transparent
10731 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010733 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010734 Arguments : none
10735
10736 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
10737 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10738 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10739 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10740 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10741 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10742 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10743 appropriate server.
10744
10745 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10746 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10747
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010010748 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010749 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010750
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010751
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010752external-check command <command>
10753 Executable to run when performing an external-check
10754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10755 yes | no | yes | yes
10756
10757 Arguments :
10758 <command> is the external command to run
10759
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010760 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
10761
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010762 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010763
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010764 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
10765 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
10766 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
10767 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10768 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10769 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010770
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010771 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10772
10773 Environment variables :
10774 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10775 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10776
10777 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10778
10779 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10780
10781 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10782 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10783 for a UNIX socket).
10784
10785 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10786
10787 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10788
10789 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10790
10791 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10792
10793 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10794
10795 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10796 socket).
10797
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020010798 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
10799
10800 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
10801 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
10802 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
10803 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
10804 TCP server).
10805
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010806 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10807 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10808
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010809 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10810
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010811 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10812 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10813 failed.
10814
10815 Example :
10816 external-check command /bin/true
10817
10818 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10819
10820
10821external-check path <path>
10822 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10824 yes | no | yes | yes
10825
10826 Arguments :
10827 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10828
10829 The default path is "".
10830
10831 Example :
10832 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10833
10834 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10835 "external-check command"
10836
10837
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010838persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010839persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010840 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10841 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10842 yes | no | yes | yes
10843 Arguments :
10844 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010845 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10846 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010847
10848 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10849 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010850 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010851 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10852 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10853 forwarded to this server.
10854
10855 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10856 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10857 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010858 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010859 a single "listen" section.
10860
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010861 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10862 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10863 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10864
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010865 Example :
10866 listen tse-farm
10867 bind :3389
10868 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10869 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10870 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10871 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10872 persist rdp-cookie
10873 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010874 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010875 balance rdp-cookie
10876 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10877 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10878
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010879 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010880
10881
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010882rate-limit sessions <rate>
10883 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10885 yes | yes | yes | no
10886 Arguments :
10887 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10888 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10889
10890 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10891 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10892 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010893 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010894 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10895 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10896
10897 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10898 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10899 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10900 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10901
10902 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10903 listen smtp
10904 mode tcp
10905 bind :25
10906 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010907 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010908
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010909 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10910 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10911 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010912
10913 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10914
10915
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010916redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10917redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10918redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010919 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10921 no | yes | yes | yes
10922
10923 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010924 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010925
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010926 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010927 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010928 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10929 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10930 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010931
10932 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10933 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10934 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10935 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10936 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010937 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10938 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10939 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10940 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010941
10942 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10943 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10944 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10945 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10946 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10947 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010948 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010949 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010950 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10951 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10952 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010953
10954 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010955 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10956 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10957 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010958 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010959 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10960 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10961 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10962 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010963
10964 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010965 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010966
10967 - "drop-query"
10968 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10969 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10970 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10971 with a location-type redirect.
10972
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010973 - "append-slash"
10974 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10975 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10976 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10977 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10978
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010979 - "ignore-empty"
10980 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10981 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10982 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10983 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10984 of known paths using a simple map.
10985
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010986 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10987 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10988 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10989 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10990 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10991 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10992 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10993
10994 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10995 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10996 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10997 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10998 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10999 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
11000 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011001
11002 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
11003 acl clear dst_port 80
11004 acl secure dst_port 8080
11005 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011006 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011007 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011008 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
11009
11010 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011011 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
11012 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
11013 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011014 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011015
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011016 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
11017 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
11018 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
11019
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011020 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010011021 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011022
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011023 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020011024 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11025 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
11026 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011027
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011028 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
11029 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11030 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
11031
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011032 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011033
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010011034
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011035retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011036 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011037 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11038 yes | no | yes | yes
11039 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011040 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
11041 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011042
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011043 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
11044 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
11045 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
11046 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
11047 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011048
11049 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070011050 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011051 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011052
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011053 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
11054 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
11055 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011056
11057 See also : "option redispatch"
11058
11059
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011060retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020011061 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
11062 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
11063 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011064 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11065 yes | no | yes | yes
11066 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011067 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
11068 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
11069 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
11070 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
11071 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011072
11073 none never retry
11074
11075 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
11076 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
11077
11078 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
11079 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
11080 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
11081 request timeout on the server side, poor network
11082 condition, or a server crash or restart while
11083 processing the request.
11084
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020011085 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
11086 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
11087 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
11088 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
11089 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
11090 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
11091 overflow attack for example).
11092
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011093 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
11094 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
11095 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
11096 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
11097 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
11098 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
11099 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
11100 amplify denial of service attacks.
11101
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020011102 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
11103 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
11104 considered to be safe to retry.
11105
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010011106 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
11107 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
11108 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
11109 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
11110 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011111
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011112 all-retryable-errors
11113 retry request for any error that are considered
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +010011114 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
11115 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
11116 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011117
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011118 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
11119 not cumulative.
11120
11121 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
11122 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
11123 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
11124 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
11125
11126 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
11127 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
11128 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
11129 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
11130 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
11131 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
11132 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
11133 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
11134 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
11135 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
11136 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
11137 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
11138
11139 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
11140 should not use this directive.
11141
11142 The default is "conn-failure".
11143
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011144 Example:
11145 retry-on 503 504
11146
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011147 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
11148
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011149server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011150 Declare a server in a backend
11151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11152 no | no | yes | yes
11153 Arguments :
11154 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011155 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011156 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011157
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011158 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
11159 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
11160 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
11161 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011162 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
11163 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011164 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011165 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
11166 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011167 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
11168 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
11169 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
11170 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
11171 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11172 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11173 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011174 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020011175 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
11176 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
11177 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
11178 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
11179 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
11180 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011181 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11182 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011183 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
11184 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011185
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011186 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011187 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
11188 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
11189 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
11190 adding this value to the client's port.
11191
11192 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
11193 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011194 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011195
11196 Examples :
11197 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
11198 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011199 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011200 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
11201 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
11202 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011203
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020011204 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
11205 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
11206 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
11207 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
11208 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
11209
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011210 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
11211 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011212
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011213server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011214 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011215 this backend.
11216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11217 no | no | yes | yes
11218
11219 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
11220 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
11221 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
11222 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
11223 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011224
11225 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11226 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11227
11228 global
11229 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11230
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011231 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011232 load-server-state-from-file
11233
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011234 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011235 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011236
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011237server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11238 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11239 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11241 no | no | yes | yes
11242
11243 Arguments:
11244 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11245
11246 <num | range>
11247 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11248 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11249 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11250 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11251
11252 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11253
11254 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11255
11256 <params*>
11257 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11258 keyword.
11259
11260 Examples:
11261 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11262 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11263 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11264
11265 # or
11266 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11267
11268 # would be equivalent to:
11269 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11270 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11271 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11272
11273
11274
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011275source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011276source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011277source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011278 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11279 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11280 yes | no | yes | yes
11281 Arguments :
11282 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11283 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011284
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011285 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011286 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11287 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11288 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11289 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11290 supported prefixes are :
11291 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11292 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11293 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011294 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011295 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11296 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011297
11298 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11299 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011300 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11301 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11302 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011303
11304 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11305 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11306 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11307 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11308 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11309 <addr>.
11310
11311 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11312 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11313 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11314 port.
11315
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011316 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11317 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11318 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11319 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011320 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011321 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11322 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11323 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11324 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11325 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11326 HTTP header.
11327
11328 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11329 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011330 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011331 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11332 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11333 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11334 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11335 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11336 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11337 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11338
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011339 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11340 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11341 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11342 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11343 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11344 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11345
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011346 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11347 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11348 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11349 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11350
11351 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11352 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11353 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11354 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11355 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11356 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11357
11358 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11359 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11360 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11361 there are two methods :
11362
11363 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11364 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11365 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11366 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11367 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11368 of the client ranges may be used.
11369
11370 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11371 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11372 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11373 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11374 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11375 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11376 same session.
11377
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011378 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11379 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11380 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011381 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011382
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011383 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
11384
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011385 Examples :
11386 backend private
11387 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11388 source 192.168.1.200
11389
11390 backend transparent_ssl1
11391 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11392 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11393
11394 backend transparent_ssl2
11395 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11396 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11397 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11398
11399 backend transparent_ssl3
11400 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11401 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11402 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11403
11404 backend transparent_smtp
11405 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11406 # with Tproxy version 4.
11407 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11408
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011409 backend transparent_http
11410 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11411 # proxy.
11412 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011414 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011415 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11416
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011417
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011418srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11419 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11420 the connection on the server side.
11421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11422 yes | no | yes | yes
11423 Arguments :
11424 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11425
11426 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11427 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011428 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11429 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011430
11431 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11432
11433
11434srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11435 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11436 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11437 server side.
11438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11439 yes | no | yes | yes
11440 Arguments :
11441 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11442 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11443 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11444 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11445
11446 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11447 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011448 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11449 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011450
11451 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11452
11453
11454srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11455 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11457 yes | no | yes | yes
11458 Arguments :
11459 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11460 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11461 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11462 document.
11463
11464 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11465 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011466 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11467 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011468
11469 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11470
11471
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011472stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11473 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011475 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011476
11477 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11478 matched.
11479
11480 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11481 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11482
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011483 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11484 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11485 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11486 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011487
11488 Example :
11489 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11490 backend stats_localhost
11491 stats enable
11492 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11493
11494 Example :
11495 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11496 backend stats_auth
11497 stats enable
11498 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11499 stats admin if TRUE
11500
11501 Example :
11502 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11503 userlist stats-auth
11504 group admin users admin
11505 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11506 group readonly users haproxy
11507 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11508
11509 backend stats_auth
11510 stats enable
11511 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11512 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11513 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11514 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11515
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011516 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11517 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011518
11519
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011520stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11521 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011523 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011524 Arguments :
11525 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11526
11527 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11528
11529 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11530 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11531 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11532 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11533 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11534 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11535
11536 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11537 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11538 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011539 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011540
11541 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11542 report using "stats scope".
11543
11544 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11545 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11546 unobvious parameters.
11547
11548 Example :
11549 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11550 backend public_www
11551 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11552 stats enable
11553 stats hide-version
11554 stats scope .
11555 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011556 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011557 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11558 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11559
11560 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11561 backend private_monitoring
11562 stats enable
11563 stats uri /admin?stats
11564 stats refresh 5s
11565
11566 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11567
11568
11569stats enable
11570 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11571 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011572 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011573 Arguments : none
11574
11575 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11576 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11577 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11578 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11579 - stats auth : no authentication
11580 - stats scope : no restriction
11581
11582 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11583 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11584 unobvious parameters.
11585
11586 Example :
11587 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11588 backend public_www
11589 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11590 stats enable
11591 stats hide-version
11592 stats scope .
11593 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011594 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011595 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11596 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11597
11598 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11599 backend private_monitoring
11600 stats enable
11601 stats uri /admin?stats
11602 stats refresh 5s
11603
11604 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11605
11606
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011607stats hide-version
11608 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011610 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011611 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011612
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011613 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11614 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11615 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11616 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11617 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11618 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011620 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11621 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11622 unobvious parameters.
11623
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011624 Example :
11625 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11626 backend public_www
11627 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011628 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011629 stats hide-version
11630 stats scope .
11631 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011632 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011633 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11634 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011635
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011636 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11637 backend private_monitoring
11638 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011639 stats uri /admin?stats
11640 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010011641
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011642 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011643
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011644
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011645stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11646 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11647 Access control for statistics
11648
11649 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11650 no | no | yes | yes
11651
11652 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11653 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11654 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11655 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11656 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11657 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11658
11659 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11660 instance.
11661
11662 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11663 about ACL usage.
11664
11665
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011666stats realm <realm>
11667 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011669 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011670 Arguments :
11671 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
11672 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
11673 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
11674
11675 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
11676 using a backslash ('\').
11677
11678 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
11679 only related to authentication.
11680
11681 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11682 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11683 unobvious parameters.
11684
11685 Example :
11686 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11687 backend public_www
11688 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11689 stats enable
11690 stats hide-version
11691 stats scope .
11692 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011693 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011694 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11695 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11696
11697 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11698 backend private_monitoring
11699 stats enable
11700 stats uri /admin?stats
11701 stats refresh 5s
11702
11703 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
11704
11705
11706stats refresh <delay>
11707 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
11708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011709 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011710 Arguments :
11711 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
11712 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
11713 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
11714 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
11715 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
11716 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
11717
11718 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
11719 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
11720 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050011721 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011722
11723 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11724 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11725 unobvious parameters.
11726
11727 Example :
11728 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11729 backend public_www
11730 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11731 stats enable
11732 stats hide-version
11733 stats scope .
11734 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011735 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011736 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11737 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11738
11739 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11740 backend private_monitoring
11741 stats enable
11742 stats uri /admin?stats
11743 stats refresh 5s
11744
11745 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11746
11747
11748stats scope { <name> | "." }
11749 Enable statistics and limit access scope
11750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011751 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011752 Arguments :
11753 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
11754 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
11755 section in which the statement appears.
11756
11757 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
11758 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
11759 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
11760 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
11761 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
11762 exists.
11763
11764 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11765 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11766 unobvious parameters.
11767
11768 Example :
11769 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11770 backend public_www
11771 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11772 stats enable
11773 stats hide-version
11774 stats scope .
11775 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011776 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011777 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11778 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11779
11780 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11781 backend private_monitoring
11782 stats enable
11783 stats uri /admin?stats
11784 stats refresh 5s
11785
11786 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11787
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011788
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011789stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011790 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11791 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011792 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011793
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011794 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011795 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11796
11797 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11798 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11799
11800 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11801 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011802 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011803
11804 Example :
11805 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11806 backend private_monitoring
11807 stats enable
11808 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11809 stats uri /admin?stats
11810 stats refresh 5s
11811
11812 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11813 global section.
11814
11815
11816stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011817 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11818 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11819 yes | yes | yes | yes
11820 Arguments : none
11821
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011822 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011823 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11824 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11825 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11826 - IP (socket, server)
11827 - cookie (backend, server)
11828
11829 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11830 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011831 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011832
11833 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11834
11835
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011836stats show-modules
11837 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11839 yes | yes | yes | yes
11840 Arguments : none
11841
11842 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11843 values as a tooltip.
11844
11845 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11846 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11847 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11848
11849 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11850
11851
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011852stats show-node [ <name> ]
11853 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011855 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011856 Arguments:
11857 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11858 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11859
11860 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11861 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011862 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011863
11864 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11865 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11866 unobvious parameters.
11867
11868 Example:
11869 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11870 backend private_monitoring
11871 stats enable
11872 stats show-node Europe-1
11873 stats uri /admin?stats
11874 stats refresh 5s
11875
11876 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11877 section.
11878
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011879
11880stats uri <prefix>
11881 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011883 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011884 Arguments :
11885 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11886 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11887 query string.
11888
11889 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11890 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11891 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11892 possible to reach it in the application.
11893
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011894 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011895 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011896 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11897 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11898 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11899 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11900
11901 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11902 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11903 an address or a port to statistics only.
11904
11905 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11906 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11907 unobvious parameters.
11908
11909 Example :
11910 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11911 backend public_www
11912 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11913 stats enable
11914 stats hide-version
11915 stats scope .
11916 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011917 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011918 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11919 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11920
11921 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11922 backend private_monitoring
11923 stats enable
11924 stats uri /admin?stats
11925 stats refresh 5s
11926
11927 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11928
11929
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011930stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11931 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011933 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011934
11935 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011936 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011937 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011938 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011939 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11940
11941 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11942 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11943 the "stick-table" statement.
11944
11945 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11946 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11947 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11948 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11949 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11950
11951 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11952 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11953 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11954 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11955 transformation rules.
11956
11957 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11958 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11959 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11960 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11961 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11962 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11963 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11964
11965 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11966 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11967 ACL based conditions.
11968
11969 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11970 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11971 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11972 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11973
11974 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11975 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11976 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11977 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11978
11979 Example :
11980 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11981 # last 30 minutes
11982 backend pop
11983 mode tcp
11984 balance roundrobin
11985 stick store-request src
11986 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11987 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11988 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11989
11990 backend smtp
11991 mode tcp
11992 balance roundrobin
11993 stick match src table pop
11994 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11995 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11996
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011997 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11998 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011999
12000
12001stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12002 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
12003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12004 no | no | yes | yes
12005
12006 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
12007 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
12008 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
12009 for writing more maintainable configurations.
12010
12011 Examples :
12012 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010012013 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012014
12015 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
12016 stick match src table pop if !localhost
12017 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
12018
12019
12020 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
12021 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
12022 backend http
12023 mode http
12024 balance roundrobin
12025 stick on src table https
12026 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
12027 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
12028 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
12029
12030 backend https
12031 mode tcp
12032 balance roundrobin
12033 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12034 stick on src
12035 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12036 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12037
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012038 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012039
12040
12041stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12042 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
12043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12044 no | no | yes | yes
12045
12046 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012047 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012048 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012049 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012050 server is selected.
12051
12052 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12053 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12054 the "stick-table" statement.
12055
12056 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12057 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12058 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
12059 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
12060 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
12061 address.
12062
12063 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12064 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
12065 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
12066 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
12067 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
12068 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
12069 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
12070 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
12071 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
12072 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
12073
12074 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12075 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12076 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12077 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12078 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12079 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12080 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12081
12082 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
12083 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12084 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
12085 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12086
12087 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
12088 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12089 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12090 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12091 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12092 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012093 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
12094 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12095 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12096 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12097 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12098 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012099
12100 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
12101 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
12102 the request.
12103
12104 Example :
12105 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12106 # last 30 minutes
12107 backend pop
12108 mode tcp
12109 balance roundrobin
12110 stick store-request src
12111 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12112 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12113 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12114
12115 backend smtp
12116 mode tcp
12117 balance roundrobin
12118 stick match src table pop
12119 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12120 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12121
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012122 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012123
12124
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012125stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012126 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012127 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080012128 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012130 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012131
12132 Arguments :
12133 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
12134 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
12135 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12136 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12137
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010012138 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
12139 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
12140 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12141 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12142
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012143 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
12144 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
12145 instance.
12146
12147 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
12148 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
12149 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
12150 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
12151 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
12152 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012153 to 32 characters.
12154
12155 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
12156 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
12157 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012158 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012159 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
12160 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012161
12162 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012163 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
12164 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012165 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
12166 increase.
12167
12168 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012169 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
12170 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
12171 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012172
12173 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012174 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012175 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
12176 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012177 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012178 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
12179 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
12180 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
12181 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
12182 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
12183 parameter (see below).
12184
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012185 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
12186 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
12187 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
12188 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
12189 soft restart.
12190
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012191 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012192 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
12193 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012194 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
12195 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012196 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012197 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012198 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
12199 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012200 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
12201 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012202
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012203 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
12204 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
12205 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
12206 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
12207 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
12208 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
12209 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
12210 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
12211 token.
12212
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012213 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
12214 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
12215 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
12216 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012217 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
12218 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
12219 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
12220 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
12221 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
12222 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
12223 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
12224 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12225 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12226 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12227 types and their arguments.
12228
12229 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12230 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12231 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12232 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12233
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012234 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12235 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12236 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12237 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12238 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12239 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12240 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12241 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12242 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12243 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012244 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12245 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12246 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12247 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012248
12249 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12250 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12251 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12252 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12253 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12254 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012255 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12256 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12257 update message can fit into the buffer.
12258 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12259 store only the counter gpc0.
12260 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012261 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12262 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12263 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012264 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12265 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12266 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12267 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012268
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012269 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12270 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12271 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012272 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012273
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012274 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12275 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12276 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012277 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012278 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012279 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012280
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012281 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12282 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12283 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12284 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12285
12286 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12287 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12288 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12289 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12290 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12291 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12292
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012293 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12294 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12295 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12296 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12297 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012298 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12299 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12300 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12301 to store only the tag gpt0.
12302 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12303 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12304 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012305 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12306 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12307 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012308
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012309 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12310 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12311 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12312 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12313
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012314 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12315 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12316 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12317 they were received.
12318
12319 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12320 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12321 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12322 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12323 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12324
12325 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12326 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12327 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12328 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12329 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12330
12331 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12332 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12333 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12334
12335 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12336 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12337 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12338 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12339 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12340
12341 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12342 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12343 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12344 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12345 the client side.
12346
12347 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12348 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12349 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12350 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12351 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12352 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12353 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12354
12355 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12356 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12357 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12358 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12359 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12360 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012361 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012362
12363 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12364 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12365 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12366 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12367 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12368 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12369
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012370 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12371 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12372 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12373 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12374 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12375
12376 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12377 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12378 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12379 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12380 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12381 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12382
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012383 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012384 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012385 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12386 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12387
12388 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12389 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12390 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12391 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12392 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12393 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12394 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12395 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12396 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12397 recommended for better fairness.
12398
12399 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012400 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012401 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12402 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12403
12404 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12405 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12406 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12407 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12408 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12409 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12410 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12411 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12412 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12413 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012414
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012415 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12416 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012417 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12418 reference it.
12419
12420 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12421 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012422 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12423 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12424 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012425
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012426 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12427 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12428 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12429 something that can be ignored.
12430
12431 Example:
12432 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12433 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12434 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12435 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12436
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012437 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012438 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012439
12440
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012441stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012442 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12444 no | no | yes | yes
12445
12446 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012447 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012448 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012449 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012450 server is selected.
12451
12452 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12453 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12454 the "stick-table" statement.
12455
12456 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12457 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12458 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12459 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12460
12461 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12462 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12463 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12464 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12465 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12466 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012467 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012468 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12469 rules.
12470
12471 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12472 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12473 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12474 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12475 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12476 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12477 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12478
12479 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12480 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12481 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12482 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12483
12484 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12485 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12486 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12487 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12488 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12489 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012490 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12491 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12492 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12493 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12494 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12495 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12496 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12497 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12498 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012499
12500 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12501
12502 Example :
12503 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12504 backend https
12505 mode tcp
12506 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012507 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012508 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012509
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012510 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
12511 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012512
12513 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12514 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12515 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12516
12517 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12518 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012519
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012520 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12521 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12522 # at offset 44.
12523
12524 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012525 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012526
12527 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012528 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012529
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012530 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12531 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12532
12533 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12534 extraction.
12535
12536
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012537tcp-check comment <string>
12538 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12539 it fails.
12540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12541 yes | no | yes | yes
12542
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012543 Arguments :
12544 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12545 rule fails.
12546
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012547 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12548 user-friendly error reporting.
12549
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012550 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12551 "tcp-check expect".
12552
12553
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012554tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12555 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012556 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012557 Opens a new connection
12558 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012559 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012560
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012561 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012562 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12563
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012564 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012565 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012566
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012567 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012568 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12569 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012570 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012571
12572 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012573
12574 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12575
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012576 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12577
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012578 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12579
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012580 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12581
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012582 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12583 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12584 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12585 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12586
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012587 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12588 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12589 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12590 haproxy -vv.
12591
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012592 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012593
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012594 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12595 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12596 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
12597
12598 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
12599 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
12600 of the sequence.
12601
12602 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
12603 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12604 do.
12605
12606 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12607 unset-var or comment rules.
12608
12609 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012610 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12611 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12612 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12613 option tcp-check
12614 tcp-check connect
12615 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12616 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12617 tcp-check send \r\n
12618 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12619 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12620 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12621 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12622 tcp-check send \r\n
12623 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12624 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
12625
12626 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
12627 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012628 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012629 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12630 tcp-check connect port 143
12631 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12632 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
12633
12634 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
12635
12636
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012637tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012638 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012639 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012640 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012641 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012642 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012643 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012644
12645 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012646 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12647
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012648 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
12649 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12650 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12651 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12652 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12653 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12654 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12655 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12656 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12657 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12658
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012659 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012660 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12661 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012662 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12663 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12664 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12665
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012666 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12667 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12668 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012669 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
12670 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012671 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12672 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012673 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
12674 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012675 By default "L7OK" is used.
12676
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012677 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12678 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012679 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
12680 supported :
12681 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12682 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012683 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12684 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
12685 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12686 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
12687 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012688
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012689 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012690 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012691 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
12692 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12693 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12694 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012695 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
12696
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020012697 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12698 informational message reported in logs if the expect
12699 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
12700 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
12701
12702 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12703 informational message reported in logs if an error
12704 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
12705 log-format string.
12706
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012707 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
12708 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
12709 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12710 followed by some converters.
12711
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012712 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
12713 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
12714 with the usual backslash ('\').
12715 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012716 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012717 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
12718 used upper or lower case.
12719
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012720 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
12721
12722 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
12723 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12724 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
12725 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12726 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
12727 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
12728 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
12729 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
12730
12731 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
12732 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12733 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
12734 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12735 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
12736 expression.
12737
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012738 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
12739 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12740 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
12741 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
12742 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12743 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
12744
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012745 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
12746 in the response buffer. A health check response will
12747 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
12748 this exact hexadecimal string.
12749 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
12750
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012751 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
12752 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
12753 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
12754 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
12755 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
12756 size of the original response. As such, the expected
12757 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
12758 size.
12759
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012760 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
12761 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
12762 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
12763 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
12764 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
12765 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12766 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
12767 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
12768 in a binary string before matching the response's
12769 buffer.
12770
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012771 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012772 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012773 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
12774 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
12775 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
12776 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
12777 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
12778 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
12779 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
12780 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
12781 the null character.
12782
12783 Examples :
12784 # perform a POP check
12785 option tcp-check
12786 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12787
12788 # perform an IMAP check
12789 option tcp-check
12790 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12791
12792 # look for the redis master server
12793 option tcp-check
12794 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020012795 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012796 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12797 tcp-check expect string role:master
12798 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
12799 tcp-check expect string +OK
12800
12801
12802 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012803 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012804
12805
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012806tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
12807tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
12808 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
12809 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012811 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012812
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012813 Arguments :
12814 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12815
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012816 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12817 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012818
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012819 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12820 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012821
12822 Examples :
12823 # look for the redis master server
12824 option tcp-check
12825 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12826 tcp-check expect string role:master
12827
12828 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012829 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012830
12831
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012832tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12833tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12834 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12835 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012836 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012837 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012838
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012839 Arguments :
12840 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012841
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012842 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12843 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012844
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012845 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12846 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12847 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012848
12849 Examples :
12850 # redis check in binary
12851 option tcp-check
12852 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12853 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12854
12855
12856 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012857 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012858
12859
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010012860tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
12861tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012862 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012864 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012865
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012866 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012867 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12868 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12869 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12870 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12871 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12872 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12873 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12874 and '-'.
12875
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012876 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12877 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012878 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012879 conditions.
12880
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012881 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12882
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012883 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12884 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12885
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012886 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012887 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012888 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012889
12890
12891tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012892 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012893 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012894 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012895
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012896 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012897 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12898 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12899 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12900 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12901 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12902 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12903 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12904 and '-'.
12905
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012906 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012907 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12908
12909
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012910tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012911 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012913 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012914 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012915 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12916 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012917
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012918 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012919
12920 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12921 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012922 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12923 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12924 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12925 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12926 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12927 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012928
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012929 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12930 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12931 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012932 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12933 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12934 is true.
12935
12936 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12937 supported:
12938 - accept
12939 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12940 - expect-proxy layer4
12941 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010012942 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012943 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12944 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12945 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12946 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12947 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12948 - set-dst <expr>
12949 - set-dst-port <expr>
12950 - set-mark <mark>
12951 - set-src <expr>
12952 - set-src-port <expr>
12953 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010012954 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
12955 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010012956 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012957 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12958 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12959 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012960 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012961
12962 The supported actions are described below.
12963
12964 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12965 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012966
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012967 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12968 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12969 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12970 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12971 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12972 a defaults section defining such rules.
12973
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012974 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12975 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12976 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012977
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012978 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12979 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12980 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012981
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012982 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12983 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12984 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012985
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012986 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12987 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12988 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012989
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012990 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12991 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12992 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012993
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012994 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012995
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012996 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012997
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012998 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012999
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013000 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013001
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013002tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013003
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013004 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13005 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013006
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013007tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13008 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013009
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013010 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
13011 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
13012 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
13013 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
13014 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
13015 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
13016 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013017
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013018tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013019
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013020 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
13021 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
13022 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
13023 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
13024 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
13025 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013026
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013027tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013028
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013029 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13030 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
13031 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
13032 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
13033 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
13034 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
13035 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
13036 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
13037 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
13038 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
13039 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013040
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013041tcp-request connection sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13042 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13043
13044 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13045 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13046 a complete description.
13047
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013048tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13049tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13050tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013051
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013052 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13053 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13054 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13055 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013056
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013057tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13058 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13059tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13060 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013061
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013062 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13063 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13064 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013065
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013066tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13067tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013068
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013069 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13070 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13071 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013072
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013073tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013074
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013075 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13076 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13077 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013078
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013079tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13080tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013081
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013082 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13083 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13084 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013085
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013086tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013087
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013088 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13089 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13090 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013091
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013092tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13093tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013094
13095 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13096 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
13097 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13098 for a complete description.
13099
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013100tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013101
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013102 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13103 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13104 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13105 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013106
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013107tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13108tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13109tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013110
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013111 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13112 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13113 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013114
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013115tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13116
13117 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13118 details about variables.
13119
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013120
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013121tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13122 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013124 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013125 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013126 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13127 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013128
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013129 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013130
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013131 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013132 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13133 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013134 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
13135 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013136
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013137 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
13138 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
13139 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
13140 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013141 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013142 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013143 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
13144 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
13145 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
13146 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013147 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013148 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013149
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013150 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13151 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13152 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13153 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013154
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013155 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13156 supported:
13157 - accept
13158 - capture <sample> len <length>
13159 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13160 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013161 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013162 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013163 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013164 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013165 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010013166 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013167 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013168 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020013169 - set-dst <expr>
13170 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013171 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013172 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013173 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013174 - set-priority-class <expr>
13175 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013176 - set-src <expr>
13177 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013178 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013179 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13180 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013181 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013182 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013183 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13184 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13185 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013186 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013187 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013188
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013189 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013190
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013191 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
13192 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
13193 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
13194 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
13195 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
13196 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013197
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013198 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13199 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13200 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13201 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13202 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13203 a defaults section defining such rules.
13204
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013205 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013206 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13207 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013208
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020013209 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
13210 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
13211 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
13212 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
13213 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
13214 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
13215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013216 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020013217 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
13218 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
13219 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
13220 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
13221 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
13222 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
13223 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
13224 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
13225 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
13226 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013227
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013228 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013229 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
13230 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
13231 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013232
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013233 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013234 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013235
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013236 Example:
13237
13238 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013239 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013240 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013241
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013242 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013243 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013244 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013245 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13246 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013247 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013248 tcp-request content reject
13249
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013250 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13251 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13252 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13253 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13254 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13255 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13256 ...
13257 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13258
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013259 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013260 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13261 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013262 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013263 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013264
13265 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13266 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013267 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013268 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013269 tcp-request content reject
13270
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013271 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013272 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013273 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013274 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013275 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13276 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013277
13278 Example:
13279 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13280 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013281 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013282
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013283 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013284 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013285
13286 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013287 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013288 # protecting all our sites
13289 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013290 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13291 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013292 ...
13293 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13294
13295 backend http_dynamic
13296 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013297 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013298 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013299 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013300 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013301 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013302 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013304 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013305
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013306 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13307 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013308
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013309tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13310
13311 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013312 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013313
13314tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13315 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13316
13317 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13318 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13319 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13320 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13321 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13322 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13323 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13324 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13325 information.
13326
13327tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13328
13329 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13330 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13331 complete description.
13332
13333tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13334
13335 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13336 are evaluated.
13337
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013338tcp-request content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13339 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13340
13341 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13342 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13343 a complete description.
13344
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013345tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13346tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13347tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13348
13349 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13350 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13351 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13352 description.
13353
13354tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13355 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13356tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13357 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13358
13359 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13360 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13361 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
13362
13363tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13365
13366 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13367 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13368
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013369tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13370 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013371
13372 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13373 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13374 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13375
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013376tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13377tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13378
13379 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13380 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13381 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13382
13383tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13384
13385 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13386 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13387
13388tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13389
13390 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13391 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13392 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13393
13394tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13395
13396 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13397 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13398
13399tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13400
13401 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13402 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13403
13404tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13405
13406 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13407 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13408 description.
13409
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013410tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13411tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13412
13413 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13414 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13415 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13416
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013417tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13418
13419 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13420 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13421 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13422
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013423tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13424tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013425
13426 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13427 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13428 for a complete description.
13429
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013430tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013431
13432 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13433 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13434 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13435 complete description.
13436
13437tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13438 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13439
13440 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13441 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13442 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13443 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13444 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13445 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13446 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13447 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13448 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13449 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13450
13451 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13452
13453tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13454tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13455tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13456
13457 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13458 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13459 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13460
13461tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13462
13463 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13464 details about variables.
13465
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013466tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013467
13468 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13469 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13470 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13471 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13472 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13473
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013474
13475tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13476 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013478 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013479 Arguments :
13480 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13481 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13482 as explained at the top of this document.
13483
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013484 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013485 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13486 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13487 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13488 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13489
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013490 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13491 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13492 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13493 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13494
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013495 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013496 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013497 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013498 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013499 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013500 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13501 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13502 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013503
13504 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13505 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13506 it pass through unaffected.
13507
13508 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13509 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13510 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013511 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013512 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13513 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013514 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13515 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13516 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013517
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013518 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13519 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13520
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013521 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013522 "timeout client".
13523
13524
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013525tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13526 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013528 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013529 Arguments :
13530 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13531 below.
13532
13533 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13534
13535 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13536 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13537 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13538 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013539 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013540 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13541 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13542 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13543 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13544 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13545 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13546 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13547 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13548 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13549 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13550 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13551 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13552 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13553 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13554 instead.
13555
13556 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13557 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13558 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13559 rules which may be inserted.
13560
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013561 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13562 supported:
13563 - accept
13564 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013565 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013566 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13567 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13568 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13569 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13570 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013571 - set-dst <expr>
13572 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013573 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013574 - set-src <expr>
13575 - set-src-port <expr>
13576 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013577 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13578 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013579 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013580 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13581 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13582 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13583 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013584
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013585 The supported actions are described below.
13586
13587 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13588 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13589 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13590 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13591 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13592 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013593
13594 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13595 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13596 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
13597
13598 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
13599 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
13600 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
13601 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
13602 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
13603
13604 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
13605 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13606
13607 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13608 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
13609 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
13610
13611 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13612 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
13613 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13614
13615 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
13616 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13617 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
13618
13619 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13620 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13621 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
13622
13623 See section 7 about ACL usage.
13624
13625 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
13626
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013627tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13628
13629 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
13630 rules are evaluated.
13631
13632tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13633
13634 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
13635 are evaluated.
13636
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013637tcp-request session sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13638 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13639
13640 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13641 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13642 a complete description.
13643
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013644tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13645tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13646tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13647
13648 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13649 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13650 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13651 description.
13652
13653tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13654 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13655tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13656 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13657
13658 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13659 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
13660 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
13661 description.
13662
13663tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13664tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13665
13666 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13667 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13668 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13669
13670tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13671
13672 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13673 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13674 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13675
13676tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13677tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13678
13679 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13680 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13681 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13682
13683tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13684
13685 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13686 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13687 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13688
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013689tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13690tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013691
13692 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13693 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13694 for a complete description.
13695
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013696tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013697
13698 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13699 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13700 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13701 complete description.
13702
13703tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13704tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13705tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13706
13707 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13708 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13709 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13710
13711tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13712
13713 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13714 details about variables.
13715
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013716
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013717tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13718 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
13719 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013720 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013721 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013722 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13723 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013724
13725 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13726
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013727 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013728 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13729 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013730 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
13731 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013732
13733 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
13734
13735 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13736 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13737 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13738 inserted.
13739
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013740 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13741 supported:
13742 - accept
13743 - close
13744 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013745 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013746 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13747 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13748 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13749 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13750 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13751 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013752 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013753 - set-log-level <level>
13754 - set-mark <mark>
13755 - set-nice <nice>
13756 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013757 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13758 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013759 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013760 - unset-var(<var-name>)
13761
13762 The supported actions are described below.
13763
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013764 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13765 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13766 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13767 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13768 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13769 a defaults section defining such rules.
13770
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013771 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13772 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13773 for changing the default action to a reject.
13774
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013775 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013776
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013777 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
13778 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
13779 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
13780 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
13781 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013782
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013783 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013784
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013785 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013786
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013787tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013788
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013789 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13790 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013791
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013792tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013793
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013794 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
13795 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
13796 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
13797 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
13798 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
13799 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013800
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013801tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013802
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013803 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13804 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013805
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013806tcp-response content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13807 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13808
13809 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13810 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13811 a complete description.
13812
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013813tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13814tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13815tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013816
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013817 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13818 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13819 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13820 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013821
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013822tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13823 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13824tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13825 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013826
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013827 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13828 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13829 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013830
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013831tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13832 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013833
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013834 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13835 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013836
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013837
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013838tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13839 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013840
13841 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13842 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13843 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13844
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013845tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013846
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013847 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13848 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013849
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013850tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013851
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013852 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13853 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13854 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013855
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013856tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013857
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013858 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13859 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013860
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013861tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013862
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013863 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13864 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13865 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013866
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013867tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13868tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013869
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013870 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13871 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13872 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013873
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013874tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013875
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013876 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13877 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13878 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13879 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013880
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013881tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013882
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013883 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13884 details about variables.
13885
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013886
13887tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
13888 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
13889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013890 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013891 Arguments :
13892 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13893 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13894 as explained at the top of this document.
13895
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013896 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13897 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013898
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013899 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
13900
13901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013902timeout check <timeout>
13903 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
13904 established.
13905
13906 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13907 yes | no | yes | yes
13908 Arguments:
13909 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13910 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13911 as explained at the top of this document.
13912
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013913 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013914 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013915 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013916 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013917 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13918 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13919 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013920
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013921 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013922 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13923
13924 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13925 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013926 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013927
13928 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13929 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13930 forget about it.
13931
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013932 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13933 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13934
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013935 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13936 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013937
13938
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013939timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013940 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13942 yes | yes | yes | no
13943 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013944 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013945 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13946 as explained at the top of this document.
13947
13948 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13949 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13950 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013951 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13952 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13953 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13954 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013955 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13956 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13957 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013958 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013959 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013960 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13961 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013962 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13963 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013964
13965 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13966 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13967 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13968 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013969 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013970 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13971
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013972 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013973
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013974
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013975timeout client-fin <timeout>
13976 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13978 yes | yes | yes | no
13979 Arguments :
13980 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13981 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13982 as explained at the top of this document.
13983
13984 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13985 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13986 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13987 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13988 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13989 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13990 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013991 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13992 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13993 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013994
13995 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13996 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13997 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13998
13999 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
14000
14001
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014002timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014003 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
14004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14005 yes | no | yes | yes
14006 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014007 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014008 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14009 as explained at the top of this document.
14010
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014011 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014012 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014013 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014014 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014015 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
14016 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014017
14018 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14019 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14020 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14021 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014022 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014023 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14024
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014025 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014026
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014027
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014028timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
14029 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
14030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14031 yes | yes | yes | yes
14032 Arguments :
14033 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14034 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14035 as explained at the top of this document.
14036
14037 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
14038 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
14039 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
14040 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
14041 once the request has started to present itself.
14042
14043 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
14044 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
14045 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
14046 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
14047 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
14048
14049 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
14050 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
14051 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
14052 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
14053
14054 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
14055 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014056 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014057 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
14058 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014059 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014060
14061 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
14062 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
14063 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
14064 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
14065
14066 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
14067
14068
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014069timeout http-request <timeout>
14070 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
14071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014072 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014073 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014074 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014075 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14076 as explained at the top of this document.
14077
14078 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
14079 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
14080 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
14081 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
14082 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
14083 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
14084 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014085 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
14086 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
14087 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
14088 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014089 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014090 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
14091 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014092
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014093 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
14094 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
14095 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
14096 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
14097 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014098 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014099
14100 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
14101 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014102 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014103 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
14104 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
14105
14106 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014107 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
14108 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
14109 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014110
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014111 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014112 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014113
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014114
14115timeout queue <timeout>
14116 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
14117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14118 yes | no | yes | yes
14119 Arguments :
14120 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14121 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14122 as explained at the top of this document.
14123
14124 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
14125 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
14126 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
14127 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
14128 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
14129
14130 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
14131 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
14132 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
14133 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
14134
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014135 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014136
14137
14138timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014139 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
14140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14141 yes | no | yes | yes
14142 Arguments :
14143 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14144 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14145 as explained at the top of this document.
14146
14147 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14148 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14149 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
14150 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
14151 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
14152 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
14153 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
14154
14155 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14156 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14157 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
14158 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
14159 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014160 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014161 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014162 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
14163 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014164 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
14165 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014166
14167 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14168 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14169 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14170 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014171 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014172 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14173
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014174 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014175
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014176
14177timeout server-fin <timeout>
14178 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
14179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14180 yes | no | yes | yes
14181 Arguments :
14182 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14183 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14184 as explained at the top of this document.
14185
14186 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14187 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14188 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14189 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14190 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
14191 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14192 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
14193 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
14194 situations, it should not be needed.
14195
14196 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14197 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14198 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
14199
14200 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
14201
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014202
14203timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014204 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14206 yes | yes | yes | yes
14207 Arguments :
14208 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
14209 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14210 as explained at the top of this document.
14211
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014212 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
14213 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
14214 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014215
14216 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14217 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14218 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
14219 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014220 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014221
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014222 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014223
14224
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014225timeout tunnel <timeout>
14226 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
14227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14228 yes | no | yes | yes
14229 Arguments :
14230 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14231 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14232 as explained at the top of this document.
14233
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014234 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014235 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
14236 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
14237 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014238 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
14239 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014240 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
14241 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
14242 specified.
14243
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014244 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
14245 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
14246 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
14247 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
14248 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
14249 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
14250 state.
14251
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014252 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14253 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14254 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
14255 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014256 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014257
14258 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14259 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14260 forget about it.
14261
14262 Example :
14263 defaults http
14264 option http-server-close
14265 timeout connect 5s
14266 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014267 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014268 timeout server 30s
14269 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14270
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014271 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014272
14273
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014274transparent (deprecated)
14275 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014277 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014278 Arguments : none
14279
14280 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14281 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14282 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14283 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14284 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14285 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14286 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14287 appropriate server.
14288
14289 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14290
14291 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14292 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14293
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014294 See also: "option transparent"
14295
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014296unique-id-format <string>
14297 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14299 yes | yes | yes | no
14300 Arguments :
14301 <string> is a log-format string.
14302
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014303 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14304 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14305 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14306 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014307
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014308 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014309 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014310 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14311 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14312 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14313 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14314 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14315 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014316
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014317 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14318 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014319
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014320 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014321
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014322 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014323
14324 will generate:
14325
14326 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14327
14328 See also: "unique-id-header"
14329
14330unique-id-header <name>
14331 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14333 yes | yes | yes | no
14334 Arguments :
14335 <name> is the name of the header.
14336
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014337 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14338 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014339
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014340 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014341
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014342 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014343 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14344
14345 will generate:
14346
14347 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14348
14349 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014350
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014351use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014352 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014353 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14354 no | yes | yes | no
14355 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014356 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14357 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014358
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014359 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14360 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014361
14362 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14363 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14364 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014365 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014366 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014367 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14368 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014369
14370 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14371 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14372 assign the backend.
14373
14374 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14375 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14376 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14377 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14378 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14379 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14380
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014381 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014382 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014383 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14384 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14385 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14386
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014387 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14388 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14389 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14390 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14391 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14392 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14393 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14394 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14395 cannot be forced from the request.
14396
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014397 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014398 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14399 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14400
14401 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14402 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014403
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014404use-fcgi-app <name>
14405 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14407 no | no | yes | yes
14408 Arguments :
14409 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14410
14411 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014412
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014413use-server <server> if <condition>
14414use-server <server> unless <condition>
14415 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14417 no | no | yes | yes
14418 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014419 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14420 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014421
14422 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14423
14424 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14425 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14426 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14427
14428 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14429 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14430 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14431 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14432 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14433 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14434 matches will assign the server.
14435
14436 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14437 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14438 with the next rules until one matches.
14439
14440 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14441 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14442 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14443 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14444
14445 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14446 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14447 stripped.
14448
14449 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14450 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014451 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014452 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014453 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014454
14455 Example :
14456 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014457 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014458 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014459 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014460 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014461 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014462 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014463 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14464 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14465
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014466 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14467 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14468 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14469 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014470 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014471 and we fall back to load balancing.
14472
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014473 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014474
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100144765. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014477--------------------------
14478
14479The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14480depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14481settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14482written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14483described in this section.
14484
14485
144865.1. Bind options
14487-----------------
14488
14489The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14490as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14491no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14492parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14493while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14494provided immediately after the setting name.
14495
14496The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14497
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014498accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14499 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14500 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14501 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14502 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14503 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14504 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14505 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14506 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14507 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014508 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14509 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14510 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014511
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014512accept-proxy
14513 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014514 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14515 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014516 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14517 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14518 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14519 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014520 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014521 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14522 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014523 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14524 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014525
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014526allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014527 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014528 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014529 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014530 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14531 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014532
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014533alpn <protocols>
14534 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14535 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14536 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014537 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014538 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014539 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
14540 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14541 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
14542 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
14543 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
14544 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
14545 preference, like below :
14546
14547 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014548
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014549 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14550 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
14551
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014552backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014553 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014554 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14555
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014556curves <curves>
14557 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14558 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14559 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14560 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14561 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14562 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14563
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014564ecdhe <named curve>
14565 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014566 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14567 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014568
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014569ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014570 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14571 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014572 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14573 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014574 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014575
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014576 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14577 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14578 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14579 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14580 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014581 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014582
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014583ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14584 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14585 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014586 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14587 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14588 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14589 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14590 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014591 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14592 error is ignored.
14593
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014594ca-sign-file <cafile>
14595 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14596 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
14597 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
14598 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14599 'generate-certificates' for details.
14600
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000014601ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014602 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
14603 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
14604 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14605 'generate-certificates' for details.
14606
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014607ca-verify-file <cafile>
14608 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
14609 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
14610 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
14611 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
14612 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
14613
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014614ciphers <ciphers>
14615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14616 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000014617 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014618 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014619 information and recommendations see e.g.
14620 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14621 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14622 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
14623
14624ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14625 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14626 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
14627 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
14628 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014629 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
14630 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014631
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014632crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014633 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14634 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020014635 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
14636 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014637
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014638crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014639 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14640 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
14641 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
14642 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
14643 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010014644 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
14645 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014646
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010014647 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
14648 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
14649
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014650 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
14651 are loaded.
14652
14653 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010014654 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020014655 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
14656 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
14657 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
14658 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
14659 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
14660 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
14661 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020014662 www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used, HAProxy will not start
14663 unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014664
14665 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
14666 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
14667 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
14668 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010014669 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
14670 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014671
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020014672 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014673
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014674 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014675 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014676 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
14677 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014678 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
14679 clients).
14680
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014681 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014682 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
14683 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
14684 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
14685 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
14686 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
14687 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
14688 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
14689 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
14690 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
14691 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
14692 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
14693 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
14694
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014695 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010014696 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
14697 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
14698 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
14699 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
14700
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050014701 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
14702 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
14703 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
14704 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014705
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014706 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
14707 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
14708 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014709
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014710crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014711 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014712 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
14713 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14714 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14715 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14716 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14717 in new version of OpenSSL.
14718 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14719 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014720
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014721crt-list <file>
14722 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014723 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
14724 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014725
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014726 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
14727
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020014728 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
14729 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
14730 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
14731 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
14732 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014733
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014734 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014735 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
14736 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
14737 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
14738 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
14739 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014740 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
14741 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
14742 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014743
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014744 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
14745 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
14746 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014747
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014748 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
14749
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014750 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014751 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014752 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
14753 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
14754 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
14755 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
14756 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
14757 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014758
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014759 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014760 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014761 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014762 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014763 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014764 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014765
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014766defer-accept
14767 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14768 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
14769 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014770 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014771 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
14772 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
14773 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
14774 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
14775 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
14776 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
14777 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
14778
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014779expose-fd listeners
14780 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
14781 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010014782 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
14783 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014784 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014785
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014786force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014787 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014788 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014789 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014790 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014791
14792force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014793 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014794 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014795 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014796
14797force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014798 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014799 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014800 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014801
14802force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014803 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014804 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014805 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014806
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014807force-tlsv13
14808 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
14809 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014810 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014811
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014812generate-certificates
14813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14814 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
14815 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
14816 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
14817 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
14818 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
14819 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
14820 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
14821 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
14822 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
14823 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
14824
14825 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
14826 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014827 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014828 certificate is used many times.
14829
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014830gid <gid>
14831 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
14832 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14833 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
14834 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
14835 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14836
14837group <group>
14838 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
14839 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
14840 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
14841 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
14842 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14843
14844id <id>
14845 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
14846 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
14847 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
14848 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
14849
14850interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010014851 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
14852 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
14853 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
14854 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
14855 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
14856 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010014857 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
14858 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
14859 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
14860 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
14861 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
14862 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014863
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014864level <level>
14865 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
14866 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
14867 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014868 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014869 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
14870 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
14871 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014872 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014873 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014874 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014875 all counters).
14876
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020014877severity-output <format>
14878 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
14879 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
14880 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
14881 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
14882 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
14883 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
14884 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
14885 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
14886 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
14887 rfc5424 convention.
14888
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014889maxconn <maxconn>
14890 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
14891 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
14892 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
14893 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
14894 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
14895 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
14896 eat all memory.
14897
14898mode <mode>
14899 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
14900 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
14901 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
14902 UNIX sockets.
14903
14904mss <maxseg>
14905 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
14906 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
14907 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
14908 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
14909 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
14910 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
14911 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
14912 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
14913 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
14914 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
14915 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
14916
14917name <name>
14918 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
14919 page.
14920
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014921namespace <name>
14922 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14923 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
14924 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14925 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14926
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014927nice <nice>
14928 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
14929 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
14930 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
14931 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
14932 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14933 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14934 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14935 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14936 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14937 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14938 one for an RDP socket.
14939
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014940no-ca-names
14941 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14942 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014943 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014944
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014945no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014946 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014947 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014948 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014949 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014950 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14951 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014952
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014953no-tls-tickets
14954 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14955 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14956 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014957 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14958 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014959 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14960 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14961 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014962
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014963no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014964 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014965 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014966 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014967 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014968 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14969 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014970
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014971no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014972 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014973 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014974 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014975 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014976 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14977 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014978
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014979no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014980 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014981 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014982 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014983 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014984 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14985 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014986
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014987no-tlsv13
14988 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14989 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14990 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14991 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014992 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14993 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014994
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014995npn <protocols>
14996 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14997 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14998 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014999 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015000 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010015001 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15002 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
15003 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
15004 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
15005 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015006
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015007ocsp-update [ off | on ]
15008 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
15009 Its value defaults to 'off'.
15010 This option can only be used in a crt-list line so that is applies to only
15011 one certificate at a time. If a given certificate is used in multiple
15012 crt-lists with different values of the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be
15013 raised.
15014 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
15015 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
15016 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
15017 the OCSP certid to be built.
15018 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
15019 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
15020 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
15021 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
15022 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
15023 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
15024 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
15025 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
15026 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
15027 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
15028 short time after init.
15029 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
15030 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +010015031 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init. The
15032 default minimum and maximum delays (5 minutes and 1 hour respectively) can be
15033 configured by the "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay" and
15034 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay" global options.
15035
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015036 Whenever an OCSP response is updated by the auto update task or following a
15037 call to the "update ssl ocsp-response" CLI command, a dedicated log line is
15038 emitted. It follows a dedicated log-format that contains the following header
15039 "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft" and is followed by specific OCSP-related information:
15040 - the path of the corresponding frontend certificate
15041 - a numerical update status
15042 - a textual update status
15043 - the number of update failures for the given response
15044 - the number of update successes for the givan response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb33fe2f2023-02-28 17:46:25 +010015045 See "show ssl ocsp-updates" CLI command for a full list of error codes and
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015046 error messages. This line is emitted regardless of the success or failure of
15047 the concerned OCSP response update.
15048 The OCSP request/response is sent and received through an http_client
15049 instance that has the dontlog-normal option set and that uses the regular
15050 HTTP log format in case of error (unreachable OCSP responder for instance).
15051 If such an error occurs, another log line that contains HTTP-related
15052 information will then be emitted alongside the "regular" OCSP one (which will
15053 likely have "HTTP error" as text status).
15054
15055 but if a purely HTTP error happens
15056 (unreachable OCSP responder for instance), an extra log line that follows the
15057 regular HTTP log-format will be emitted.
15058 Here are two examples of such log lines, with a successful OCSP update log line first
15059 and then an example of an HTTP error with the two different lines:
15060 <134>Mar 6 11:16:53 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:16:52.808] <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/foo.pem 1 "Update successful" 0 1
15061
15062 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:54.207] <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/bar.pem 2 "HTTP error" 1 0
15063 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:52.200] <OCSP-UPDATE> -/- 2/0/-1/-1/3009 503 217 - - SC-- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0 {} "GET http://127.0.0.1:12345/MEMwQTA%2FMD0wOzAJBgUrDgMCGgUABBSKg%2BAGD6%2F3Ccp%2Bm5VSKi6BY1%2FaCgQU9lKw5DXV6pI4UVCPCtvpLYXeAHoCAhAV HTTP/1.1"
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015064
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015065prefer-client-ciphers
15066 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
15067 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
15068 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020015069 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
15070 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
15071 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015072
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015073proto <name>
15074 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
15075 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
15076 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015077 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
15078 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15079
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015080 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15081 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15082 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015083
15084 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15085 a bind line :
15086
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015087 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015088 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15089 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15090
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015091 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015092 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080015093 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015094 h2" on the bind line.
15095
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020015096quic-cc-algo [ cubic | newreno ]
15097 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
15098
15099 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
15100 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
15101 to those used by TCP.
15102
15103 Default value: cubic
15104
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015105quic-force-retry
15106 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
15107 change without deprecation in the future.
15108
15109 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
15110 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
15111 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
15112 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
15113 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
15114 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
15115 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010015116 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
15117
15118 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
15119 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015120
15121 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
15122 information about QUIC retry.
15123
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015124shards <number> | by-thread
15125 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
15126 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
15127 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
15128 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
15129 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
15130 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
15131 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
15132 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
15133 little bit.
15134
15135 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
15136 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
15137 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
15138 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
15139 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
15140 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
15141
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015142ssl
15143 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015144 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015145 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
15146 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020015147 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
15148 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015149
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015150ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15151 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015152 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
15153 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
15154 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015155 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15156
15157ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015158 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
15159 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
15160 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
15161 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015162
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015163strict-sni
15164 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
15165 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015166 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
15167 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
15168 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
15169 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
15170 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015171
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015172tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015173 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015174 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015175 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015176 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015177 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
15178 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
15179 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
15180 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
15181 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
15182 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
15183 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15184
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015185tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010015186 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015187 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
15188 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
15189 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
15190 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
15191 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
15192 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
15193 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020015194 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
15195 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
15196 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015197
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015198thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>[,...]
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015199 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
15200 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
15201 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015202
15203 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
15204 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015205 It is also possible to designate a thread number using its relative number
15206 inside its thread group, by specifying the thread group number first, then a
15207 slash ('/') and the relative thread number(s). In this case thread numbers
15208 also start at 1 and end at 32 or 64 depending on the platform. When absolute
15209 thread numbers are specified, they will be automatically translated to
15210 relative numbers once thread groups are known. Usually, absolute numbers are
15211 preferred for simple configurations, and relative ones are preferred for
15212 complex configurations where CPU arrangement matters for performance.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015213
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015214 After the optional thread group number, the "thread-set" specification must
15215 use the following format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015216
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015217 "all" | "odd" | "even" | [number][-[number]]
15218
15219 As their names imply, "all" validates all threads within the set (either all
15220 of the group's when a group is specified, or all of the process' threads),
15221 "odd" validates all odd-numberred threads (every other thread starting at 1)
15222 either for the process or the group, and "even" validates all even-numberred
15223 threads (every other thread starting at 2). If instead thread number ranges
15224 are used, then all threads included in the range from the first to the last
15225 thread number are validated. The numbers are either relative to the group
Willy Tarreau7fd87562023-02-28 08:19:37 +010015226 or absolute depending on the presence of a thread group number. If the first
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015227 thread number is omitted, "1" is used, representing either the first thread
15228 of the group or the first thread of the process. If the last thread number is
15229 omitted, either the last thread number of the group (32 or 64) is used, or
15230 the last thread number of the process (global.nbthread).
15231
15232 These ranges may be repeated and delimited by a comma, so that non-contiguous
15233 thread sets can be specified, and the group, if present, must be specified
15234 again for each new range. Note that it is not permitted to mix group-relative
15235 and absolute specifications because the whole "bind" line must use either
15236 an absolute notation or a relative one, as those not set will be resolved at
15237 the end of the parsing.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015238
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015239 The main purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but
15240 not the same thread in a listener, so that the system can distribute the
15241 incoming connections into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue
15242 load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015243
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015244tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
15245 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010015246 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
15247 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
15248 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
15249 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
15250 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
15251 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
15252 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
15253 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
15254 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
15255 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015256 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
15257 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
15258
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015259transparent
15260 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15261 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
15262 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
15263 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
15264 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
15265 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
15266 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
15267 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
15268 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
15269 so check for support with your vendor.
15270
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015271v4v6
15272 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15273 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
15274 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
15275 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015276 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015277
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015278v6only
15279 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15280 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
15281 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015282 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
15283 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015284
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015285uid <uid>
15286 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
15287 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15288 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
15289 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
15290 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15291
15292user <user>
15293 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
15294 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15295 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
15296 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
15297 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15298
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015299verify [none|optional|required]
15300 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
15301 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
15302 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
15303 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
15304 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015305 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
15306 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
15307 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
15308 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020015309
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200153105.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015311------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015312
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015313The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15314which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15315arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15316settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15317after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15318Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15319address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015320
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015321 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015322 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015323
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015324Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15325keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15326
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015327The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015328
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015329addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015330 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015331 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15332 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15333 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15334 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15335 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015336
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015337agent-check
15338 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015339 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015340 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15341 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15342 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015343
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015344 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015345 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015346 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015347 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15348 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015349
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015350 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15351 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15352 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15353 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15354 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015355
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015356 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015357 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015358
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015359 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15360 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15361 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015362
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015363 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15364 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15365 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015366
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015367 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015368 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15369 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15370 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15371 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015372 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015373 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015374
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015375 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15376 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015377
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015378 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15379 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15380 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15381 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15382 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15383 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15384 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15385 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15386 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015387
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015388 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15389 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015390 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15391 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15392 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015393 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015394
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015395 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015396 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015397
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015398agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015399 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015400 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15401 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15402 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15403 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15404
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015405agent-inter <delay>
15406 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15407 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15408
15409 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15410 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15411 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15412 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15413 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15414 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15415 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15416 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15417 of backends use the same servers.
15418
15419 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15420
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015421agent-addr <addr>
15422 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15423
15424 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015425 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015426 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15427 hostname, it will be resolved.
15428
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015429agent-port <port>
15430 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15431
15432 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15433
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015434allow-0rtt
15435 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015436 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15437 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015438
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015439alpn <protocols>
15440 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15441 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15442 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015443 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015444 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15445 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15446 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15447 now obsolete NPN extension.
15448 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15449 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15450
15451 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15452
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015453 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015455backup
15456 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15457 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15458 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15459 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015460 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15461 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015462
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015463ca-file <cafile>
15464 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15465 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015466 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15467 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015468 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015469
15470 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15471 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15472 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015474check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015475 This option enables health checks on a server:
15476 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
15477 considered available.
15478 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
15479 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
15480 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
15481 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
15482 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015483 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
15484 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015485 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
15486 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
15487 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
15488 exchanges succeed.
15489
15490 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
15491 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
15492 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
15493 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
15494 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050015495 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015496 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
15497
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015498 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020015499 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015500 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
15501 not overridden.
15502
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015503 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
15504 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
15505
15506 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
15507 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
15508
15509 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
15510 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
15511 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
15512 available.
15513
15514 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
15515 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
15516 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
15517
15518 Example:
15519 # simple tcp check
15520 backend foo
15521 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
15522 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
15523 backend foo
15524 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
15525 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
15526 backend foo
15527 option tcp-check
15528 tcp-check connect
15529 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015530
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020015531check-send-proxy
15532 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
15533 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
15534 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
15535 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
15536 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
15537 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
15538 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
15539
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010015540check-alpn <protocols>
15541 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
15542 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
15543 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
15544
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015545check-proto <name>
15546 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
15547 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
15548 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015549 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
15550 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15551
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015552 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15553 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15554 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015555
15556 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
15557 directive on a server line:
15558
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015559 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015560 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15561 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15562 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15563
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015564 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015565 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
15566 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
15567
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015568check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015569 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015570 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
15571 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015572
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015573check-ssl
15574 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
15575 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
15576 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
15577 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015578 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015579 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
15580 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015581 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015582 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
15583 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015584
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015585check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015586 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015587 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
15588 for normal traffic.
15589
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015590ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015591 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
15592 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
15593 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015594 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
15595 information and recommendations see e.g.
15596 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
15597 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
15598 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015599
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015600ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
15601 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
15602 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
15603 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
15604 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015605 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
15606 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
15607 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015609cookie <value>
15610 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
15611 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
15612 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
15613 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
15614 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
15615 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
15616 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
15617
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015618crl-file <crlfile>
15619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15620 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
15621 to verify server's certificate.
15622
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020015623crt <cert>
15624 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
15625 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
15626 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
15627 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
15628 certificate request.
15629
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020015630 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
15631 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
15632 option is set accordingly).
15633
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015634disabled
15635 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
15636 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
15637 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
15638 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
15639 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015640 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015641
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015642enabled
15643 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
15644 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
15645 default value.
15646 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
15647 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015648
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015649error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010015650 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
15651 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
15652 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015653
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015654 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015655
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015656fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015657 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
15658 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
15659 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
15660
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015661force-sslv3
15662 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15663 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015664 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015665 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015666
15667force-tlsv10
15668 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015669 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015670 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015671
15672force-tlsv11
15673 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015674 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015675 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015676
15677force-tlsv12
15678 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015679 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015680 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015681
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015682force-tlsv13
15683 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15684 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015685 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015686
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015687id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020015688 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
15689 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
15690 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015691
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015692init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
15693 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
15694 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015695 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015696 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
15697 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
15698 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
15699 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
15700 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
15701 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
15702 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
15703 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
15704 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015705 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015706 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
15707 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
15708 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
15709 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
15710 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
15711 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015712 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015713
15714 Example:
15715 defaults
15716 # never fail on address resolution
15717 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
15718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015719inter <delay>
15720fastinter <delay>
15721downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015722 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
15723 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15724 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
15725 between checks depending on the server state :
15726
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020015727 Server state | Interval used
15728 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15729 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
15730 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15731 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
15732 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
15733 or yet unchecked. |
15734 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15735 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
15736 | "inter" otherwise.
15737 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015739 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
15740 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
15741 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
15742 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015743 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15744 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15745 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15746 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15747 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015748
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020015749log-proto <logproto>
15750 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
15751 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
15752 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
15753 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
15754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015755maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015756 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
15757 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015758 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
15759 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015760 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
15761 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
15762 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
15763 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
15764
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015765 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
15766 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
15767 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
15768 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
15769 than 50 concurrent requests.
15770
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015771maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015772 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
15773 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
15774 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
15775 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020015776 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
15777 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
15778 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
15779 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
15780 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
15781 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
15782 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015783
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010015784max-reuse <count>
15785 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
15786 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
15787 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
15788 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
15789 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
15790 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
15791 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
15792 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
15793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015794minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015795 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
15796 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
15797 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
15798 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
15799 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
15800 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015801 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015802 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015803
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015804namespace <name>
15805 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15806 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
15807 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15808 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15809
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015810no-agent-check
15811 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
15812 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15813 default value.
15814 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15815 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
15816
15817no-backup
15818 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
15819 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15820 default value.
15821 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15822 "default-server" "backup" setting.
15823
15824no-check
15825 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
15826 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15827 default value.
15828 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15829 "default-server" "check" setting.
15830
15831no-check-ssl
15832 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
15833 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15834 default value.
15835 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15836 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
15837
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015838no-send-proxy
15839 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
15840 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15841 default value.
15842 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15843 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
15844
15845no-send-proxy-v2
15846 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
15847 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15848 default value.
15849 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15850 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
15851
15852no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
15853 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
15854 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15855 default value.
15856 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15857 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
15858
15859no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15860 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
15861 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15862 default value.
15863 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15864 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
15865
15866no-ssl
15867 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
15868 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15869 default value.
15870 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15871 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
15872
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010015873 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
15874 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
15875 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
15876
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010015877no-ssl-reuse
15878 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
15879 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
15880 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
15881 and for paranoid users.
15882
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015883no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015884 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15885 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015886 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015887
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015888 Supported in default-server: No
15889
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015890no-tls-tickets
15891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15892 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15893 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015894 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
15895 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015896 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15897 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15898 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015899 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015900
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015901no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015902 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015903 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15904 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015905 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15906 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015907 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015908
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015909 Supported in default-server: No
15910
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015911no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015912 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015913 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15914 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015915 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15916 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015917 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015918
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015919 Supported in default-server: No
15920
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015921no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015922 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015923 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15924 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015925 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15926 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015927 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015928
15929 Supported in default-server: No
15930
15931no-tlsv13
15932 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15933 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15934 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
15935 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15936 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015937 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015938
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015939 Supported in default-server: No
15940
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015941no-verifyhost
15942 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
15943 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15944 default value.
15945 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15946 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015947
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015948no-tfo
15949 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
15950 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15951 default value.
15952 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15953 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
15954
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090015955non-stick
15956 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
15957 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
15958 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
15959
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015960npn <protocols>
15961 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15962 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15963 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015964 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015965 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
15966 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15967 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
15968
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015969observe <mode>
15970 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
15971 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
15972 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
15973 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
15974 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
15975 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010015976 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015977
15978 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
15979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015980on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015981 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
15982 Currently, four modes are available:
15983 - fastinter: force fastinter
15984 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
15985 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
15986 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
15987 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
15988
15989 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
15990
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015991on-marked-down <action>
15992 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
15993 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015994 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
15995 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
15996 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
15997 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
15998 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
15999 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
16000 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
16001 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016002
16003 Actions are disabled by default
16004
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016005on-marked-up <action>
16006 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
16007 Currently one action is available:
16008 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
16009 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
16010 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
16011 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016012 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
16013 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016014 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
16015 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
16016
16017 Actions are disabled by default
16018
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016019pool-low-conn <max>
16020 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
16021 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
16022 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
16023 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
16024 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
16025 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
16026 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
16027 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
16028 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
16029 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010016030 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
16031 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
16032 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
16033 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016034
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010016035pool-max-conn <max>
16036 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
16037 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
16038 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
16039 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
16040 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
16041 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
16042
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016043pool-purge-delay <delay>
16044 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010016045 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020016046 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016047
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016048port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016049 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010016050 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
16051 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
16052 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
16053 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
16054 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016055
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016056proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016057 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
16058 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
16059 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016060 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
16061 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16062
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016063 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16064 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16065 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016066
16067 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
16068 a server line :
16069
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016070 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016071 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16072 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16073 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16074
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016075 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016076 protocol for all connections established to this server.
16077
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016078 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
16079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016080redir <prefix>
16081 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
16082 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
16083 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
16084 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
16085 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
16086 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
16087 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
16088 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016089 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016090 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016091 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
16092 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
16093 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
16094 loop between the client and HAProxy!
16095
16096 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
16097
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016098rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016099 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
16100 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
16101 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
16102
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016103resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
16104 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
16105 server.
16106
16107 Available options:
16108
16109 * allow-dup-ip
16110 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
16111 resolution at runtime is in operation.
16112 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
16113 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
16114 For such case, simply enable this option.
16115 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
16116
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050016117 * ignore-weight
16118 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
16119 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
16120 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
16121
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016122 * prevent-dup-ip
16123 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
16124 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
16125 same fqdn.
16126 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
16127
16128 Example:
16129 backend b_myapp
16130 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
16131 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16132 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16133
16134 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
16135 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
16136 it
16137 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
16138 different address
16139
16140 Default value: not set
16141
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016142resolve-prefer <family>
16143 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
16144 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
16145 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
16146 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
16147
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020016148 Default value: ipv6
16149
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016150 Example:
16151
16152 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016153
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016154resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016155 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016156 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016157 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016158 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
16159 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016160 configured network, another address is selected.
16161
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016162 Example:
16163
16164 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016165
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016166resolvers <id>
16167 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
16168 hostname.
16169
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016170 Example:
16171
16172 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016173
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016174 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016175
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016176send-proxy
16177 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
16178 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
16179 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
16180 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016181 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
16182 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
16183 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
16184 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016185 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016186 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
16187 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
16188 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
16189 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
16190 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016191 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
16192 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016193
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016194send-proxy-v2
16195 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
16196 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16197 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16198 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020016199 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
16200 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
16201 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
16202 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016203
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016204proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010016205 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
16206 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
16207
16208 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
16209 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
16210 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
16211 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
16212 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
16213 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
16214 connection is supported).
16215 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
16216 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
16217 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
16218 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
16219 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
16220 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
16221 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016222
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016223send-proxy-v2-ssl
16224 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16225 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16226 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16227 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16228 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16229 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
16230 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016231 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
16232 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016233
16234send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16235 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16236 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16237 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16238 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16239 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16240 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
16241 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
16242 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016243 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
16244 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016245
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020016246shard <shard>
16247 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
16248 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
16249 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
16250 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
16251 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
16252 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
16253 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
16254
16255 Example :
16256
16257 peers mypeers
16258 shards 3
16259 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
16260 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
16261 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
16262 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
16263
16264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016265slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016266 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
16267 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
16268 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
16269 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
16270 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
16271 parameters :
16272
16273 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
16274 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
16275
16276 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
16277 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
16278 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
16279 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
16280
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016281 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016282 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
16283 seen as failed.
16284
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016285sni <expression>
16286 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
16287 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
16288 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010016289 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
16290 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
16291 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
16292 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020016293 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016294 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010016295 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
16296 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016297
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016298source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020016299source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016300source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016301 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
16302 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
16303 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
16304 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
16305
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016306 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
16307 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
16308 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
16309 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
16310 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16311 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16312 server.
16313
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016314 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16315 specifying the source address without port(s).
16316
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016317ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016318 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16319 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16320 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16321 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16322 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16323 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016324 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16325 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016326
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016327ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16328 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16329 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16330 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16331
16332ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16333 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16334 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16335 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16336
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016337ssl-reuse
16338 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16339 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16340 default value.
16341 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16342 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16343
16344stick
16345 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16346 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16347 default value.
16348 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16349 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016350
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016351socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016352 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016353 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16354 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16355
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016356tcp-ut <delay>
16357 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016358 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016359 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016360 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016361 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16362 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16363 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16364 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16365 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16366 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16367 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16368 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16369 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16370
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016371tfo
16372 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16373 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16374 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16375 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016376 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016377 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016379track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016380 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16381 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16382 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
16383 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016384 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16385
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016386tls-tickets
16387 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16388 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16389 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016390 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16391 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16392 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016393 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016394 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016395
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016396verify [none|required]
16397 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016398 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016399 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16400 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016401 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016402 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16403 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16404 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16405 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16406 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16407 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16408 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16409 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016410
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016411verifyhost <hostname>
16412 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016413 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16414 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16415 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16416 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16417 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16418 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16419 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16420 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016422weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016423 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16424 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16425 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016426 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16427 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16428 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16429 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16430 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16431 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016432
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016433ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16434 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16435 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16436 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16437
16438 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16439 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16440 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16441 server ALPN contains it.
16442
16443 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16444 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16445 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16446 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16447
16448 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16449 favor of the ALPN extension.
16450
16451 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16452
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016453
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200164545.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16455-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016456
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016457HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16458using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016459configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016460This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16461can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16462workload.
16463This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16464resolution at run time.
16465Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16466carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16467
16468
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200164695.3.1. Global overview
16470----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016471
16472As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16473different steps of the process life:
16474
16475 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16476 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
16477 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
16478
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016479 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
16480 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016481
16482A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
16483 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
16484 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
16485 resolution to know this new IP.
16486
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016487When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016488HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016489SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
16490from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016491will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016492will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020016493
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016494A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016495 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016496 first valid response.
16497
16498 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
16499 servers return an error.
16500
16501
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200165025.3.2. The resolvers section
16503----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016504
16505This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016506HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
16507contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016508
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020016509At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
16510no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
16511default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
16512failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
16513
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016514When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
16515uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
16516is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
16517answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
16518
16519When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016520used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016521
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016522 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
16523 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
16524 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016525
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016526 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
16527 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016528
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010016529 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016530 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
16531 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016532
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016533For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
16534following scenarios are possible:
16535
16536 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
16537 ignored
16538
16539 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
16540 applied
16541
16542 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
16543 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
16544
16545 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
16546 retries the query with a new type
16547
16548 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
16549 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016550
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016551As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016552a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016553<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016554
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016555
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016556resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016557 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016558
16559A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
16560
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016561accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016562 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016563 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016564 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
16565 by RFC 6891)
16566
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010016567 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
16568 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
16569 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
16570 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
16571 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
16572 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020016573
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016574nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
16575 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
16576 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
16577 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
16578 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
16579 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
16580 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
16581 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
16582 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
16583 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010016584 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
16585
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016586parse-resolv-conf
16587 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
16588 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
16589 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
16590
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016591hold <status> <period>
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010016592 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
16593 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
16594 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
16595 counteract the just received invalid status.
16596
16597 <status> : last name resolution status.
16598 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
16599 status during the concluding period.
16600
16601 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
16602 status during the concluding period.
16603
16604 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
16605 valid status during the concluding period.
16606
16607 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
16608 valid status during the concluding period.
16609
16610 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
16611 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
16612 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
16613 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
16614 dynamic resolution of servers.
16615
16616 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
16617 records after an updated answer record is received. It
16618 applies to SRV records.
16619
16620 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
16621 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
16622 milliseconds by default.
16623
16624 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
16625 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
16626 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
16627 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
16628 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
16629
16630 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
16631 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
16632 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
16633 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
16634
16635 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
16636 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016637
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010016638 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016639
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016640resolve_retries <nb>
16641 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
16642 giving up.
16643 Default value: 3
16644
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016645 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
16646 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
16647 type.
16648
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016649timeout <event> <time>
16650 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
16651 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
16652 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016653 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
16654 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016655 Default value: 1s
16656 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016657 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016658 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016659 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
16660 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
16661
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016662 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016663
16664 resolvers mydns
16665 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
16666 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016667 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016668 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016669 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016670 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016671 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010016672 hold other 30s
16673 hold refused 30s
16674 hold nx 30s
16675 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016676 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016677 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016678
16679
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200166806. Cache
16681---------
16682
16683HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
16684(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
16685RAM.
16686
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020016687The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
16688blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016689
16690If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
16691independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
16692when we try to allocate a new one.
16693
16694The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
16695
16696It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
16697"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
16698for more details.
16699
16700When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
16701replaced by "<CACHE>".
16702
16703
167046.1. Limitation
16705----------------
16706
16707The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
16708
16709- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010016710- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
16711 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
16712 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016713- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
16714- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010016715- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
16716 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
16717 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016718- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
16719 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010016720- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
16721 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
16722 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016723
16724- If the request is not a GET
16725- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
16726- If the request contains an Authorization header
16727
16728
167296.2. Setup
16730-----------
16731
16732To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
16733the corresponding http-request and response actions.
16734
16735
167366.2.1. Cache section
16737---------------------
16738
16739cache <name>
16740 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
16741 size of cache is mandatory.
16742
16743total-max-size <megabytes>
16744 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
16745 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
16746
16747max-object-size <bytes>
16748 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
16749 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
16750 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
16751
16752max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016753 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016754 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
16755 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
16756 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
16757 default.
16758
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016759process-vary <on/off>
16760 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016761 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
16762 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
16763 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016764 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016765
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016766max-secondary-entries <number>
16767 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
16768 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
16769 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
16770
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016771
167726.2.2. Proxy section
16773---------------------
16774
16775http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16776 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
16777 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
16778 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
16779 after this one.
16780
16781http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16782 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
16783 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
16784 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
16785 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
16786
16787
16788Example:
16789
16790 backend bck1
16791 mode http
16792
16793 http-request cache-use foobar
16794 http-response cache-store foobar
16795 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
16796
16797 cache foobar
16798 total-max-size 4
16799 max-age 240
16800
16801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200168027. Using ACLs and fetching samples
16803----------------------------------
16804
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016805HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016806client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
16807The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
16808these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
16809but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
16810data called patterns.
16811
16812
168137.1. ACL basics
16814---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016815
16816The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
16817content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
16818from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
16819simple :
16820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016821 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016822 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016823 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
16824 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016826The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
16827adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016828
16829In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
16830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016831 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016832
16833This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
16834Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
16835and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016836an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
16837conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
16838as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
16839are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016840
16841ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
16842'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
16843which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
16844
16845There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
16846performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
16847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016848The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
16849specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
16850this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016851methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
16852ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016853
16854Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
16855 - boolean
16856 - integer (signed or unsigned)
16857 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
16858 - string
16859 - data block
16860
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016861Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
16862converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
16863would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
16864The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
16865which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
16866
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016867Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
16868keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
16869fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
16870which are summarized in the table below :
16871
16872 +---------------------+-----------------+
16873 | Sample or converter | Default |
16874 | output type | matching method |
16875 +---------------------+-----------------+
16876 | boolean | bool |
16877 +---------------------+-----------------+
16878 | integer | int |
16879 +---------------------+-----------------+
16880 | ip | ip |
16881 +---------------------+-----------------+
16882 | string | str |
16883 +---------------------+-----------------+
16884 | binary | none, use "-m" |
16885 +---------------------+-----------------+
16886
16887Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
16888matching method, see below.
16889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016890The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
16891 - boolean
16892 - integer or integer range
16893 - IP address / network
16894 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
16895 - regular expression
16896 - hex block
16897
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016898The following ACL flags are currently supported :
16899
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016900 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
16901 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016902 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016903 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016904 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016905 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016906 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
16907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016908The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
16909read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
16910if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
16911lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
16912will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
16913beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016914a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016915lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
16916exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
16917
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016918The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
16919parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
16920ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
16921a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
16922check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
16923
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016924The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
16925socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
16926file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
16927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016928Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
16929loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
16930
16931 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
16932
16933In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
16934the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
16935case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
16936as well.
16937
16938The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
16939sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
16940do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
16941methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
16942is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016943obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016944followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
16945default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
16946that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
16947string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
16948
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016949The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
16950By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
16951string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
16952resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016953server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016954waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016955flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
16956function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
16957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016958There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
16959sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
16960be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016961
16962 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
16963 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016964 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
16965 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
16966 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
16967 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016968
16969 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
16970 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016971 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016972
16973 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016974 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016975
16976 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016977 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016978
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016979 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016980 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
16981
16982 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
16983 binary or string samples.
16984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016985 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
16986 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016988 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
16989 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
16990 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016992 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
16993 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016995 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
16996 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016998 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
16999 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017001 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
17002 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017003 This may be used with binary or string samples.
17004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017005 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
17006 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
17007 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017008
17009For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
17010request, it is possible to do :
17011
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017012 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017013
17014In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
17015buffer, one would use the following acl :
17016
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017017 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017018
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017019On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
17020possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
17021
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017022 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017024All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
17025criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
17026method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010017027to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
17028usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
17029converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
17030method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
17031matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017032criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
17033the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017034
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017035If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017036the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
17037For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017039 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
17040 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
17041 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
17042 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017043
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017044
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017045The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
17046types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
17047combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
17048brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
17049default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017051 +-------------------------------------------------+
17052 | Input sample type |
17053 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017054 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017055 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17056 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
17057 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017058 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017059 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017060 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017061 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017062 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017063 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017064 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017065 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017066 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017067 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017068 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017069 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017070 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017071 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017072 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017073 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017074 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017075 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017076 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017077 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017078 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017079 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17080 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
17081 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017082
17083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170847.1.1. Matching booleans
17085------------------------
17086
17087In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
17088Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
17089When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
17090that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
17091
17092Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
17093return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
17094"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
17095
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170977.1.2. Matching integers
17098------------------------
17099
17100Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
17101enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
17102to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
17103
17104Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
17105matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
17106lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017107
17108For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
17109unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
17110representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
17111
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017112As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
17113two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
17114instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
17115ranges and operators.
17116
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017117For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017118operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
17119Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
17120of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017121
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017122Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017123
17124 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
17125 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
17126 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
17127 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
17128 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
17129
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017130For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017131
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017132 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017133
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017134This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
17135
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017136 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017137
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200171397.1.3. Matching strings
17140-----------------------
17141
17142String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
17143different forms :
17144
17145 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017146 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017147
17148 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017149 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017150
17151 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
17152 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17153
17154 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
17155 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17156
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017157 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17158 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
17159 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
17160 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
17161 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
17162 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017163
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017164 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17165 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
17166 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
17167 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
17168 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
17169 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
17170 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
17171 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
17172 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
17173 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
17174 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017175
17176String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
17177exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
17178characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
17179string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
17180to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017181before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017182
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010017183Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
17184(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
17185Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
17186
17187Example:
17188 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
17189 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
17190
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200171927.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
17193---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017194
17195Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
17196they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
17197possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
17198passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
17199the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017200the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
17201match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017202
17203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200172047.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
17205-------------------------------------
17206
17207It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
17208not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
17209a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
17210to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
17211digits may be used upper or lower case.
17212
17213Example :
17214 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017215 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017216
17217
172187.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
17219---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017220
17221IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
17222netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
17223within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010017224host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017225difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
17226at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
17227does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
17228parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017229
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020017230The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
17231abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
17232
17233 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17234 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
17235 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17236 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
17237 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
17238 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
17239 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
17240 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17241
17242Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
17243192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
17244
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020017245IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
17246Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
17247trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
17248IPv6 patterns.
17249
17250HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
17251following situations :
17252 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
17253 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
17254 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
17255 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
17256 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
17257 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
17258 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
17259 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
17260 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
17261 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
17262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017263
172647.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
17265----------------------------------
17266
17267Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
17268combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
17269
17270 - AND (implicit)
17271 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
17272 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017274A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017276 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017278Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
17279indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017281For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
17282"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
17283requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
17284is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
17285
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017286 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017287 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
17288 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
17289 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017290
17291To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
17292and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
17293
17294 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
17295 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
17296 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
17297 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
17298
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017299 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017300 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
17301 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
17302 use_backend www if host_www
17303
17304It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
17305expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
17306be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
17307the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
17308
17309 The following rule :
17310
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017311 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017312 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017313
17314 Can also be written that way :
17315
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017316 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017317
17318It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
17319to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
17320simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
17321sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
17322good use is the following :
17323
17324 With named ACLs :
17325
17326 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
17327 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
17328 monitor fail if site_dead
17329
17330 With anonymous ACLs :
17331
17332 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
17333
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017334See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
17335keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017336
17337
173387.3. Fetching samples
17339---------------------
17340
17341Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
17342against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
17343sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
17344ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
17345of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
17346available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
17347
17348This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17349Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17350compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17351deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17352
17353The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17354matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17355method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17356indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17357
17358As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17359when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17360mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17361the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17362ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17363
17364Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17365multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17366when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017367incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17368are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017369is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17370all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17371
17372Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17373 - name
17374 - name(arg1)
17375 - name(arg1,arg2)
17376
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017377
173787.3.1. Converters
17379-----------------
17380
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017381Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17382of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17383is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17384was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017385has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017386unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17387
17388These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17389sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17390the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017391support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017392
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017393A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17394support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17395supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17396(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17397bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017399The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017400
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001740151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17402 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17403 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17404 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17405 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17406 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17407
17408 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017409 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17410 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017411 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17412 frontend http-in
17413 bind *:8081
17414 default_backend servers
17415 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17416 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17417
Aurelien DARRAGON5c6f86f2022-12-30 16:23:08 +010017418rfc7239_is_valid
17419 Returns true if input header is RFC 7239 compliant header value and false
17420 otherwise.
17421
17422 Example:
17423 acl valid req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_is_valid
17424 #input: "for=127.0.0.1;proto=http"
17425 # output: TRUE
17426 #input: "proto=custom"
17427 # output: FALSE
17428
Aurelien DARRAGON6fb58b82022-12-30 16:37:03 +010017429rfc7239_field(<field>)
17430 Extracts a single field/parameter from RFC 7239 compliant header value input.
17431
17432 Supported fields are:
17433 - proto: either 'http' or 'https'
17434 - host: http compliant host
17435 - for: RFC7239 node
17436 - by: RFC7239 node
17437
17438 More info here:
17439 https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html#section-6
17440
17441 Example:
17442 # extract host field from forwarded header and store it in req.fhost var
17443 http-request set-var(req.fhost) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(host)
17444 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\""
17445 # output: "haproxy.org:80"
17446
17447 # extract for field from forwarded header and store it in req.ffor var
17448 http-request set-var(req.ffor) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for)
17449 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\";for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17450 # output: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17451
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017452rfc7239_n2nn
17453 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17454 into its corresponding nodename final form:
17455 - ipv4 address
17456 - ipv6 address
17457 - 'unknown'
17458 - '_obfs' identifier
17459
17460 Example:
17461 # extract 'for' field from forwarded header, extract nodename from
17462 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnn
17463 http-request set-var(req.fnn) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for),rfc7239_n2nn
17464 #input: "for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17465 # output: 127.0.0.1
17466 #input: "for=\"_name:_port\""
17467 # output: "_name"
17468
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017469rfc7239_n2np
17470 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17471 into its corresponding nodeport final form:
17472 - unsigned integer
17473 - '_obfs' identifier
17474
17475 Example:
17476 # extract 'by' field from forwarded header, extract node port from
17477 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnp
17478 http-request set-var(req.fnp) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(by),rfc7239_n2np
17479 #input: "by=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17480 # output: 9999
17481 #input: "by=\"_name:_port\""
17482 # output: "_port"
17483
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017484add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017485 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017486 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017487 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17488 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017489 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017490 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17491 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17492 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17493 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017494 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017495 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017496
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017497add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
17498 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
17499 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
17500 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
17501 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
17502 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17503 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
17504 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
17505 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
17506 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
17507 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
17508 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
17509 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
17510 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
17511 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
17512 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
17513 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
17514 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010017515 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
17516 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017517
17518 Example:
17519 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
17520 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
17521 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
17522 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
17523
17524 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
17525 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
17526
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010017527aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
17528 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
17529 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
17530 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
17531 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
17532 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
17533 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
17534
17535 Example:
17536 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
17537 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
17538
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017539and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017540 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017541 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017542 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17543 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017544 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017545 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17546 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17547 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17548 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017549 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017550 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017551
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017552b64dec
17553 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
17554 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017555 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
17556 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017557
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017558base64
17559 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017560 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017561 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
17562 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017563
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020017564be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
17565 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
17566 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
17567 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
17568 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
17569 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
17570
17571 Example:
17572 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
17573 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
17574 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
17575 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
17576
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020017577be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
17578 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
17579 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
17580 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
17581 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
17582 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
17583 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
17584
17585 Example:
17586 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
17587 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
17588 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
17589 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
17590
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017591bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017592 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017593 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017594 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017595 presence of a flag).
17596
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017597bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
17598 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
17599 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017600 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017601
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017602concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
17603 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
17604 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
17605 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
17606 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17607 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
17608 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
17609 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
17610 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
17611 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
17612 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017613 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040017614 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017615 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017616 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
17617 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
17618 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017619
17620 Example:
17621 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
17622 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
17623 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017624 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017625 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017626 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
17627
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017628cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017629 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
17630 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017631
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017632crc32([<avalanche>])
17633 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
17634 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17635 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17636 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17637 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17638 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
17639 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
17640 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
17641 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
17642 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017643 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
17644
17645crc32c([<avalanche>])
17646 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
17647 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17648 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17649 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
17650 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
17651 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
17652 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
17653 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017654
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020017655cut_crlf
17656 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
17657 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
17658 updated.
17659
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010017660da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017661 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
17662 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
17663 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
17664 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017665 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017666 configuration language.
17667
17668 Example:
17669 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017670 bind *:8881
17671 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000017672 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017673
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010017674debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
17675 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
17676 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
17677 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
17678 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
17679 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
17680 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
17681 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
17682 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
17683 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
17684 printable sample types.
17685
17686 Example:
17687 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020017688
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017689digest(<algorithm>)
17690 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
17691 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
17692
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017693 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017694 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17695
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017696div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017697 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17698 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017699 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017700 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
17701 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017702 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017703 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17704 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17705 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17706 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017707 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017708 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017709
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017710djb2([<avalanche>])
17711 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
17712 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17713 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17714 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17715 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17716 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17717 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017718 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
17719 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017720
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017721even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017722 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017723 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
17724
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017725field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17726 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
17727 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
17728 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
17729 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
17730 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
17731 fields.
17732
17733 Example :
17734 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
17735 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17736 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
17737 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
17738 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010017739
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017740fix_is_valid
17741 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
17742 Information eXchange):
17743
17744 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
17745 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050017746 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017747 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010017748 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017749 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
17750 checksum
17751
17752 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17753 the server can be parsed.
17754
17755 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
17756 message, false if not.
17757
17758 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
17759
17760 Example:
17761 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17762 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17763
17764fix_tag_value(<tag>)
17765 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
17766 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
17767 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
17768 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050017769 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017770 added.
17771
17772 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17773 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
17774 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
17775 fix_is_valid converter.
17776
17777 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
17778
17779 Example:
17780 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17781 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17782 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
17783 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
17784 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
17785
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017786hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017787 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017788 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017789 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017790 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010017791
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017792hex2i
17793 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017794 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017795
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020017796htonl
17797 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
17798 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
17799 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
17800 unsigned 32-bit integer.
17801
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017802hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017803 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
17804 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
17805 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
17806 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
17807
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017808 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017809 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17810
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020017811host_only
17812 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
17813 The input must respect the format of the host header value
17814 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
17815 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
17816
17817 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
17818
17819 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
17820
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017821http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017822 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17823 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017824 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
17825 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
17826 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
17827 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
17828 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
17829 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
17830 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
17831 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017832
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017833iif(<true>,<false>)
17834 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
17835 string otherwise.
17836
17837 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020017838 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017839
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017840in_table(<table>)
17841 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17842 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
17843 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017844 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017845 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
17846
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017847ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017848 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017849 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017850 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
17851 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
17852 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
17853 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
17854 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017855
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017856json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017857 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017858 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017859 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017860 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
17861 of errors:
17862 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
17863 bytes, ...)
17864 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
17865 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
17866
17867 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
17868 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
17869 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
17870 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
17871 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
17872 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017873 - "ascii" : never fails;
17874 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
17875 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017876 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017877 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017878 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
17879 characters corresponding to the other errors.
17880
17881 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017882 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017883
17884 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017885 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017886 capture request header user-agent len 150
17887 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017888
17889 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
17890 GET / HTTP/1.0
17891 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
17892
17893 Output log:
17894 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
17895
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020017896json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
17897 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
17898 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
17899 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
17900 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
17901
17902 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
17903 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
17904
17905 Example:
17906 # get a integer value from the request body
17907 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
17908 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
17909
17910 # get a key with '.' in the name
17911 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
17912 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
17913
17914 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
17915 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
17916
17917 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
17918 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
17919
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020017920jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17921 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
17922 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
17923 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
17924 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17925 json_path and output_type parameters.
17926
17927 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17928 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17929
17930jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17931 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
17932 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
17933 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
17934 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17935 json_path and output_type parameters.
17936
17937 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17938 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17939
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017940jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
17941 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
17942 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017943 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017944 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
17945 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
17946 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
17947 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017948
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017949 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010017950 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). All the
17951 algorithms mentioned in section 3.1 of RFC7518 are managed.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017952
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017953 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
17954 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
17955 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
17956 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
17957 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
17958 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017959 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017960 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
17961
17962 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
17963 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
17964 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
17965 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
17966 contents.
17967
17968 The possible return values are the following :
17969
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017970 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
17971 | ID | message |
17972 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017973 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017974 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017975 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010017976 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017977 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
17978 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
17979 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017980 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017981
17982 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17983 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17984
17985 Example:
17986 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
17987 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
17988 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
17989 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
17990 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
17991 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
17992
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017993language(<value>[,<default>])
17994 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
17995 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
17996 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
17997 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
17998 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
17999 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
18000 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
18001 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
18002 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018003 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018004 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
18005 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018006
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018007 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018008
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018009 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
18010 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018011
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018012 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
18013 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
18014 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
18015 use_backend spanish if es
18016 use_backend french if fr
18017 use_backend english if en
18018 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018019
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010018020length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010018021 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
18022 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18023 type. The result is of type integer.
18024
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018025lower
18026 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
18027 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18028 type. The result is of type string.
18029
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018030ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
18031 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18032 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
18033 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18034 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18035 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18036 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
18037
18038 Example :
18039
18040 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018041 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018042 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18043
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020018044ltrim(<chars>)
18045 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
18046 representation of the input sample.
18047
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018048map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18049map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18050map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18051 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
18052 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
18053 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
18054 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
18055 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
18056 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
18057 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
18058 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018059
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018060 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
18061 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
18062 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018063
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018064 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018065 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018066
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018067 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
18068 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18069 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
18070 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020018071 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
18072 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018073 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
18074 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18075 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
18076 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18077 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
18078 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18079 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
18080 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080018081 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
18082 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18083 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018084 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18085 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
18086 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18087 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
18088 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018089
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010018090 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
18091 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
18092 the corresponding match text.
18093
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018094 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
18095 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
18096 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
18097 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
18098 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018099
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018100 Example :
18101
18102 # this is a comment and is ignored
18103 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
18104 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
18105 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
18106 | | | `---------- value
18107 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
18108 | `---------------------------- key
18109 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
18110
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018111mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018112 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18113 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018114 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018115 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018116 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018117 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18118 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18119 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18120 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018121 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018122 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018123
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018124mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018125 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
18126 <packettype>.
18127 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
18128 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
18129 from.
18130 Supported string and integers can be found here:
18131 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
18132 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
18133
18134 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
18135 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
18136 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
18137 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
18138
18139 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
18140 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
18141 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18142 packets only):
18143 17: Session Expiry Interval
18144 33: Receive Maximum
18145 39: Maximum Packet Size
18146 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18147 25: Request Response Information
18148 23: Request Problem Information
18149 21: Authentication Method
18150 22: Authentication Data
18151 18: Will Delay Interval
18152 1: Payload Format Indicator
18153 2: Message Expiry Interval
18154 3: Content Type
18155 8: Response Topic
18156 9: Correlation Data
18157 Not supported yet:
18158 38: User Property
18159
18160 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
18161 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18162 packets only):
18163 17: Session Expiry Interval
18164 33: Receive Maximum
18165 36: Maximum QoS
18166 37: Retain Available
18167 39: Maximum Packet Size
18168 18: Assigned Client Identifier
18169 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18170 31: Reason String
18171 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
18172 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
18173 42: Shared Subscription Available
18174 19: Server Keep Alive
18175 26: Response Information
18176 28: Server Reference
18177 21: Authentication Method
18178 22: Authentication Data
18179 Not supported yet:
18180 38: User Property
18181
18182 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18183 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18184 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18185 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18186
18187 Example:
18188
18189 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
18190 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18191 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
18192 if data_in_buffer
18193 # do the same as above
18194 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18195 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
18196 if data_in_buffer
18197
18198mqtt_is_valid
18199 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
18200
18201 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18202 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18203 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18204 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18205
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010018206 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
18207
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018208 Example:
18209
18210 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040018211 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018212
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018213mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018214 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020018215 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
18216 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018217 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018218 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018219 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018220 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18221 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18222 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18223 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018224 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018225 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018226
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010018227nbsrv
18228 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
18229 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
18230 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
18231 map lookup.
18232
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018233neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018234 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
18235 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
18236 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
18237 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018238
18239not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018240 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018241 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018242 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018243 absence of a flag).
18244
18245odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018246 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018247 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
18248
18249or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018250 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018251 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018252 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18253 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018254 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018255 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18256 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18257 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18258 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018259 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018260 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018261
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070018262param(<name>,[<delim>])
18263 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
18264 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
18265 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
18266 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
18267 a value of an empty string.
18268
18269 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
18270 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
18271 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
18272 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
18273
18274 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
18275 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
18276 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
18277 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
18278 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
18279 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
18280
18281 Example :
18282 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
18283 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
18284 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
18285 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
18286 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
18287
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018288port_only
18289 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
18290 returning its port.
18291 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18292 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18293 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18294
18295 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
18296
18297 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
18298
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018299protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
18300 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
18301 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
18302 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
18303 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
18304 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18305 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18306 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18307 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
18308 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
18309 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18310 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
18311
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010018312regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018313 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
18314 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
18315 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
18316 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
18317 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
18318 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
18319 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
18320 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
18321 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018322 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
18323 of characters with other ones.
18324
18325 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
18326 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
18327 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
18328 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
18329 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
18330 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018331
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018332 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018333
18334 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
18335 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
18336 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018337 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018338
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018339 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
18340 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
18341
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018342 # capture groups and backreferences
18343 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020018344 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018345 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
18346
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018347capture-req(<id>)
18348 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
18349 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18350
18351 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018352 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18353 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018354
18355capture-res(<id>)
18356 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
18357 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18358
18359 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018360 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18361 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018362
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020018363rtrim(<chars>)
18364 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
18365 of the input sample.
18366
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018367sdbm([<avalanche>])
18368 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
18369 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18370 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18371 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18372 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18373 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18374 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018375 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
18376 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018377
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018378secure_memcmp(<var>)
18379 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
18380 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
18381 match.
18382
18383 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
18384 performed in constant time.
18385
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018386 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018387 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18388
18389 Example :
18390
18391 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
18392 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
18393 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
18394 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
18395
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010018396set-var(<var>[,<cond>...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018397 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018398 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
18399 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
18400 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18401 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018402 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018403 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18404 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018405 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018406 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18407 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018408 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018409 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018410
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018411 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
18412 possible conditions :
18413 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
18414 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
18415 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
18416 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
18417 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
18418 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
18419 Checks if the input is empty or not.
18420 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
18421 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
18422 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
18423 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
18424 called on the variable.
18425 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
18426 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
18427 configuration parsing.
18428 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
18429 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
18430 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
18431 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
18432 true by default.
18433
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018434sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018435 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018436 sample with length of 20 bytes.
18437
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018438sha2([<bits>])
18439 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
18440 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
18441
18442 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
18443 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
18444
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018445 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018446 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18447
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020018448srv_queue
18449 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
18450 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
18451 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
18452 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
18453 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
18454
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018455strcmp(<var>)
18456 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
18457 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
18458 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
18459 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
18460 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
18461 shorter).
18462
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018463 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
18464 strings in constant time.
18465
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018466 Example :
18467
18468 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
18469 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
18470 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
18471
18472
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018473sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018474 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
18475 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018476 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018477 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
18478 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018479 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018480 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18481 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018482 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018483 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18484 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018485 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018486 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018487
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018488table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
18489 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18490 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18491 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
18492 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18493 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18494 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
18495
18496
18497table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
18498 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18499 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18500 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
18501 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18502 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18503 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
18504
18505table_conn_cnt(<table>)
18506 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18507 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018508 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018509 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
18510 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18511
18512table_conn_cur(<table>)
18513 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18514 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18515 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18516 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18517 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
18518
18519table_conn_rate(<table>)
18520 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18521 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18522 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
18523 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18524 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
18525
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018526table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
18527 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18528 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18529 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18530 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
18531 input sample in the designated table.
18532 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
18533
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018534table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
18535 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18536 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18537 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
18538 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
18539 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18540 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18541 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
18542 data-type).
18543 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18544
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018545table_gpt0(<table>)
18546 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18547 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18548 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18549 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18550 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
18551
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018552table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
18553 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18554 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18555 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
18556 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
18557 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
18558 between 0 and 99.
18559 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18560 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18561 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18562 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
18563
18564table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
18565 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18566 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18567 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
18568 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
18569 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
18570 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18571 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
18572 value 0.
18573 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
18574 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18575 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
18576
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018577table_gpc0(<table>)
18578 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18579 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18580 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18581 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18582 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
18583
18584table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
18585 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18586 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18587 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
18588 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18589 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
18590 sample fetch keyword.
18591
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018592table_gpc1(<table>)
18593 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18594 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18595 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
18596 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18597 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
18598
18599table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
18600 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18601 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18602 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
18603 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18604 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
18605 sample fetch keyword.
18606
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018607table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
18608 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18609 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018610 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018611 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18612 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18613
18614table_http_err_rate(<table>)
18615 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18616 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18617 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
18618 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
18619 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
18620 keyword.
18621
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018622table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
18623 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18624 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18625 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
18626 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18627 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18628
18629table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
18630 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18631 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18632 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
18633 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
18634 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
18635 keyword.
18636
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018637table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
18638 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18639 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018640 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018641 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18642 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18643
18644table_http_req_rate(<table>)
18645 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18646 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18647 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
18648 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
18649 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
18650 keyword.
18651
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010018652table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018653 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18654 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18655 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18656 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
18657 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
18658 updated.
18659 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
18660
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018661table_kbytes_in(<table>)
18662 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18663 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018664 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018665 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18666 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18667 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
18668 keyword.
18669
18670table_kbytes_out(<table>)
18671 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18672 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018673 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018674 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18675 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18676 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
18677 keyword.
18678
18679table_server_id(<table>)
18680 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18681 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18682 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
18683 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
18684 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
18685 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
18686
18687table_sess_cnt(<table>)
18688 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18689 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018690 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018691 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
18692 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18693 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
18694 keyword.
18695
18696table_sess_rate(<table>)
18697 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18698 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18699 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
18700 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
18701 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18702 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
18703 keyword.
18704
18705table_trackers(<table>)
18706 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18707 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18708 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18709 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
18710 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
18711 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
18712 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
18713 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
18714 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
18715 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
18716
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018717ub64dec
18718 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
18719 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
18720 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
18721
18722 Example:
18723 # Decoding a JWT payload:
18724 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
18725
18726ub64enc
18727 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
18728
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018729upper
18730 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
18731 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18732 type. The result is of type string.
18733
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020018734url_dec([<in_form>])
18735 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
18736 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
18737 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
18738 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
18739 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
18740 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020018741
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010018742url_enc([<enc_type>])
18743 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
18744 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
18745 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
18746 optional argument is here for future changes.
18747
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018748ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018749 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018750 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
18751 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
18752 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018753 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18754 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18755 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18756 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018757 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018758 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18759 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018760
18761 Example:
18762 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
18763 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
18764
18765 message Point {
18766 int32 latitude = 1;
18767 int32 longitude = 2;
18768 }
18769
18770 message PPoint {
18771 Point point = 59;
18772 }
18773
18774 message Rectangle {
18775 // One corner of the rectangle.
18776 PPoint lo = 48;
18777 // The other corner of the rectangle.
18778 PPoint hi = 49;
18779 }
18780
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018781 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
18782 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
18783 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018784
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018785 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18786 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018787 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018788 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
18789
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018790 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018791
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018792 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018793
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018794 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
18795 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18796 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018797
18798 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
18799 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
18800 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
18801
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018802 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
18803 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
18804 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018805
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018806
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010018807unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010018808 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
18809 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
18810 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
18811 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18812 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
18813 response),
18814 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18815 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
18816 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
18817 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
18818
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018819utime(<format>[,<offset>])
18820 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18821 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
18822 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18823 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18824 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18825 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
18826
18827 Example :
18828
18829 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018830 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018831 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18832
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018833word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18834 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
18835 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
18836 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018837 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018838 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
18839 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
18840
18841 Example :
18842 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
18843 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18844 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
18845 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
18846 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018847 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010018848
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018849wt6([<avalanche>])
18850 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
18851 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18852 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18853 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18854 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18855 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18856 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018857 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
18858 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018859
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018860xor(<value>)
18861 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018862 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018863 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018864 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018865 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018866 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18867 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018868 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018869 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18870 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018871 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018872 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018873
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010018874xxh3([<seed>])
18875 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
18876 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
18877 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
18878 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
18879 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
18880 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
18881 considered as cryptographically secure.
18882
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010018883xxh32([<seed>])
18884 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
18885 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18886 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18887 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18888 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18889 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18890 as cryptographically secure.
18891
18892xxh64([<seed>])
18893 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
18894 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18895 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18896 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18897 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18898 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18899 as cryptographically secure.
18900
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010018901x509_v_err_str
18902 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
18903 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
18904 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
18905
18906 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
18907 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
18908 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
18909
18910 Example:
18911
18912 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18913
18914 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18915 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
18916 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
18917
18918 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
18919 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
18920 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018921
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189227.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018923--------------------------------------------
18924
18925A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
18926not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
18927"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
18928The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
18929
18930always_false : boolean
18931 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18932 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18933
18934always_true : boolean
18935 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18936 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18937
18938avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018939 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018940 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
18941 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
18942 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
18943 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
18944 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
18945 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
18946 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
18947 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
18948 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
18949 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
18950 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
18951 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
18952 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010018953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018954be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018955 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
18956 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
18957 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
18958 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018959 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
18960
18961be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
18962 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18963 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
18964 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
18965 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
18966 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018967 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
18968 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018969
18970 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
18971 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
18972 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018974be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
18975 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18976 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18977 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018978 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018979 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
18980 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018981
18982 Example :
18983 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
18984 backend dynamic
18985 mode http
18986 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
18987 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018988
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018989bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018990 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
18991 of the string.
18992
18993bool(<bool>) : bool
18994 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
18995 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
18996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018997connslots([<backend>]) : integer
18998 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018999 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019000 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
19001 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050019002
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019003 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019004 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019005 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
19006
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019007 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
19008 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019009
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019010 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019011 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019012 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019013 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019014 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019015 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019016 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019017
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019018 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
19019 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019020 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019021 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019022
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019023cpu_calls : integer
19024 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
19025 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
19026 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
19027 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
19028 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
19029 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
19030
19031cpu_ns_avg : integer
19032 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19033 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19034 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19035 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19036 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19037 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19038 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
19039 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
19040 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
19041 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
19042 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
19043
19044cpu_ns_tot : integer
19045 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19046 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19047 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19048 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19049 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19050 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19051 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
19052 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
19053 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
19054 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
19055 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
19056 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
19057 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
19058
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010019059date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019060 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019061
19062 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
19063 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
19064 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019065 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
19066
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019067 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
19068 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
19069 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
19070 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
19071 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
19072
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019073 Example :
19074
19075 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
19076 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019077
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019078 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
19079 # millisecond granularity
19080 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
19081
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010019082date_us : integer
19083 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
19084 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
19085 from the same timeval structure.
19086
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019087env(<name>) : string
19088 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
19089 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
19090 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
19091 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
19092 certain way.
19093
19094 Examples :
19095 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
19096 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
19097
19098 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019099 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019101fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
19102 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019103 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
19104 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019105 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
19106 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019107 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019108 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
19109 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019110
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020019111fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19112 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
19113 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
19114 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
19115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019116fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19117 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19118 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19119 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
19120 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
19121 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
19122 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
19123 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
19124 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019125
19126 Example :
19127 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
19128 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
19129 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
19130 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
19131 frontend mail
19132 bind :25
19133 mode tcp
19134 maxconn 100
19135 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
19136 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
19137 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
19138 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019139
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010019140hostname : string
19141 Returns the system hostname.
19142
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019143int(<integer>) : signed integer
19144 Returns a signed integer.
19145
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019146ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
19147 Returns an ipv4.
19148
19149ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
19150 Returns an ipv6.
19151
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019152last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019153 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
19154 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
19155 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19156 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19157 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19158 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19159 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19160 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19161 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19162 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19163 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19164 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
19165
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019166last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019167 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
19168 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
19169 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19170 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19171 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19172 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19173 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19174 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19175 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19176 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19177 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19178 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
19179
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019180lat_ns_avg : integer
19181 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19182 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19183 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19184 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19185 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19186 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19187 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19188 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19189 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019190 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19191 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19192 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19193 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19194 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
19195 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019196
19197lat_ns_tot : integer
19198 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19199 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19200 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19201 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19202 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19203 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19204 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19205 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19206 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019207 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19208 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19209 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19210 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19211 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019212 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
19213 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
19214 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
19215 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
19216 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
19217 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
19218
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019219meth(<method>) : method
19220 Returns a method.
19221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019222nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
19223 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
19224 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
19225 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019226 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
19227 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
19228 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019229
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040019230prio_class : integer
19231 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
19232 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
19233 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
19234
19235prio_offset : integer
19236 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
19237 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
19238 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
19239 set-priority-offset".
19240
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019241proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020019242 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
19243 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019245queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019246 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
19247 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
19248 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019249 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
19250 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
19251 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
19252 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
19253 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
19254
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019255quic_enabled : boolean
19256 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
19257 change without deprecation in the future.
19258
19259 Return true when the support for QUIC transport protocol was compiled and
19260 if this procotol was not disabled by "no-quic" global option. See also "no-quic"
19261 global option.
19262
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010019263rand([<range>]) : integer
19264 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
19265 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
19266 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
19267 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
19268 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
19269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019270srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19271 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19272 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
19273 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
19274 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
19275 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019276 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
19277 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
19278
19279srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19280 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19281 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
19282 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19283 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
19284 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
19285 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
19286 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
19287
19288 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
19289 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019290
19291srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
19292 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
19293 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
19294 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019295 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019296 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
19297 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
19298 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
19299
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020019300srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19301 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
19302 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19303 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
19304 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
19305 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
19306 fetch methods.
19307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019308srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19309 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19310 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019311 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019312 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
19313 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019314 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019315 overloading servers).
19316
19317 Example :
19318 # Redirect to a separate back
19319 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
19320 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
19321 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
19322
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019323srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019324 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
19325 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
19326 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
19327
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019328srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019329 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
19330 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19331 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
19332
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019333srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019334 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
19335 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19336 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
19337
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019338stopping : boolean
19339 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
19340 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
19341 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
19342
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019343str(<string>) : string
19344 Returns a string.
19345
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019346table_avl([<table>]) : integer
19347 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
19348 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
19349
19350table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19351 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
19352 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
19353 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
19354
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010019355thread : integer
19356 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
19357 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
19358 and debugging purposes.
19359
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020019360uuid([<version>]) : string
19361 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
19362 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
19363 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
19364
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019365var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019366 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019367 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
19368 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
19369 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019370 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019371 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19372 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019373 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019374 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19375 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019376 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019377 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019378
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193797.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019380----------------------------------
19381
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019382The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019383closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
19384methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
19385sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
19386TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019387the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
19388counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020019389"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010019390used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
19391counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
19392"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
19393An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
19394currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
19395the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019396
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019397bc_dst : ip
19398 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
19399 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
19400 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
19401 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19402
19403bc_dst_port : integer
19404 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019405 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019406
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019407bc_err : integer
19408 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
19409 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
19410 and their corresponding error message.
19411
19412bc_err_str : string
19413 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
19414 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
19415 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
19416 corresponding error message.
19417
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010019418bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010019419 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19420 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19421 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
19422
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019423bc_src : ip
19424 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019425 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019426 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19427 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19428
19429bc_src_port : integer
19430 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019431 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019433be_id : integer
19434 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019435 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19436 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019437
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019438be_name : string
19439 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019440 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19441 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019442
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010019443be_server_timeout : integer
19444 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
19445 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19446 also the "cur_server_timeout".
19447
19448be_tunnel_timeout : integer
19449 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
19450 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19451 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
19452
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010019453cur_server_timeout : integer
19454 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19455 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
19456 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
19457
19458cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
19459 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19460 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
19461 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
19462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019463dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019464 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
19465 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
19466 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
19467 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
19468 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
19469 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
19470 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
19471 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
19472 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
19473 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
19474 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019475
19476dst_conn : integer
19477 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19478 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
19479 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
19480 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
19481 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
19482 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
19483 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
19484 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019485
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019486dst_is_local : boolean
19487 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
19488 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
19489 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
19490 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019491 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019492 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
19493 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
19494 it only once per connection.
19495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019496dst_port : integer
19497 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
19498 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019499 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
19500 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
19501 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
19502 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019503
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019504fc_dst : ip
19505 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19506 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
19507 for details.
19508
19509fc_dst_is_local : boolean
19510 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
19511 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
19512 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
19513
19514fc_dst_port : integer
19515 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
19516 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
19517 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
19518
19519fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019520 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
19521 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
19522 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019523 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019524 error codes and their corresponding error message.
19525
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019526fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050019527 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019528 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019529 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019530 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
19531
19532 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19533 | ID | message |
19534 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19535 | 0 | "Success" |
19536 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
19537 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
19538 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
19539 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
19540 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
19541 | 6 | "General socket error" |
19542 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
19543 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
19544 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
19545 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
19546 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19547 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19548 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19549 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
19550 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
19551 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
19552 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
19553 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19554 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19555 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
19556 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
19557 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
19558 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
19559 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
19560 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
19561 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
19562 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
19563 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
19564 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
19565 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
19566 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
19567 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
19568 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
19569 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
19570 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
19571 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
19572 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
19573 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
19574 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
19575 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
19576 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
19577 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020019578 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019579 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19580
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019581fc_fackets : integer
19582 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
19583 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19584 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19585 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19586
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020019587fc_http_major : integer
19588 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19589 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19590 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
19591
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019592fc_lost : integer
19593 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
19594 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19595 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19596 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19597
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020019598fc_pp_authority : string
19599 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19600 if any.
19601
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010019602fc_pp_unique_id : string
19603 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19604 if any.
19605
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010019606fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
19607 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
19608 header.
19609
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019610fc_reordering : integer
19611 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
19612 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19613 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19614 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19615
19616fc_retrans : integer
19617 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
19618 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19619 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19620 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19621
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020019622fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19623 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
19624 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19625 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19626 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19627 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19628 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19629
19630fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
19631 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
19632 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
19633 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
19634 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19635 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19636 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19637
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020019638fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019639 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19640 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19641 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19642 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19643
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019644fc_src : ip
19645 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19646 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
19647 for details.
19648
19649fc_src_is_local : boolean
19650 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
19651 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
19652 "src_is_local" for details.
19653
19654fc_src_port : integer
19655
19656 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
19657 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
19658 this address. See "src-port" for details.
19659
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019660
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019661fc_unacked : integer
19662 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19663 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19664 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19665 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019666
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020019667fe_defbe : string
19668 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
19669 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
19670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019671fe_id : integer
19672 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010019673 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019674 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19675
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019676fe_name : string
19677 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
19678 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
19679 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19680
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010019681fe_client_timeout : integer
19682 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
19683 current frontend.
19684
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019685sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019686sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19687sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19688sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019689 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
19690 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19691 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
19692
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019693sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019694sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19695sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19696sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019697 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
19698 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19699 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
19700
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019701sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19702 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19703 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19704 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19705 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19706 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19707 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19708 will always return zero.
19709 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19710 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19711
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019712sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019713sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19714sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19715sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019716 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19717 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019718 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19719 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19720 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019721
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019722 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019723 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19724 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019725 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19726 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
19727 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019728 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19729 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19730
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019731sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19732sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19733sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19734sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19735 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19736 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
19737 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19738 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19739 when a first ACL was verified.
19740
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019741sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019742sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19743sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19744sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019745 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019746 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
19747
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019748sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019749sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19750sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19751sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019752 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19753 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
19754 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
19755
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019756sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019757sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19758sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19759sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019760 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
19761 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
19762 See also src_conn_rate.
19763
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019764sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19765 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
19766 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
19767 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
19768 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19769 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
19770 index, zero is returned.
19771 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19772 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
19773
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019774sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019775sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19776sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19777sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019778 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019779 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019780
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019781sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19782sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19783sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19784sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19785 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19786 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19787
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019788sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19789 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19790 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
19791 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19792 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19793 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
19794 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
19795 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
19796
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019797sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19798sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19799sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19800sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19801 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19802 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
19803
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019804sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19805 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19806 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
19807 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
19808 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
19809 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
19810 between 0 and 2.
19811 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
19812 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19813 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19814 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19815 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19816
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019817sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019818sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19819sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19820sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019821 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
19822 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19823 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019824 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19825 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19826 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019827
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019828sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19829sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19830sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19831sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19832 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19833 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19834 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19835 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19836 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19837 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19838
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019839sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019840sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19841sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19842sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019843 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019844 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
19845 See also src_http_err_cnt.
19846
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019847sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019848sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19849sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19850sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019851 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
19852 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19853 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
19854 src_http_err_rate.
19855
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019856sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19857sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19858sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19859sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19860 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
19861 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
19862 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
19863
19864sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19865sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19866sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19867sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19868 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
19869 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
19870 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
19871 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
19872
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019873sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019874sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19875sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19876sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019877 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019878 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19879 src_http_req_cnt.
19880
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019881sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019882sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19883sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19884sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019885 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
19886 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
19887 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19888 src_http_req_rate.
19889
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019890sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19891 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19892 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19893 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19894 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19895 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19896 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19897 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
19898 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19899 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19900
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019901sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019902sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19903sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19904sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019905 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019906 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19907 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19908 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19909 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019910
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019911 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019912 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19913 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019914 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19915
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019916sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19917sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19918sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19919sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19920 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
19921 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19922 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19923 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19924 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
19925
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019926sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019927sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19928sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19929sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019930 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
19931 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19932 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019933
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019934sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019935sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19936sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19937sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019938 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
19939 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19940 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019941
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019942sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019943sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19944sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19945sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019946 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019947 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
19948 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
19949 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019950 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019951 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
19952
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019953sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019954sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19955sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19956sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019957 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
19958 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19959 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
19960 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
19961 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019962 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019963
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019964sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019965sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19966sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19967sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020019968 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
19969 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
19970 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
19971
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019972sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019973sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19974sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19975sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019976 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19977 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019978 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019979 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
19980 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019981 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
19982 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
19983 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019985so_id : integer
19986 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
19987 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
19988 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019989
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010019990so_name : string
19991 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
19992 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
19993 strings instead of integers.
19994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019995src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019996 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
19997 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
19998 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19999 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
20000 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
20001 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
20002 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
20003 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
20004 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
20005 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
20006 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
20007 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
20008 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
20009 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
20010 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020011
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010020012 Example:
20013 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
20014 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
20015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020016src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20017 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
20018 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
20019 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020020 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020022src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20023 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
20024 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020025 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020026 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020027
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020028src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20029 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20030 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20031 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
20032 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20033 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
20034 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20035 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20036 See also sc_clr_gpc.
20037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020038src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20039 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20040 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20041 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20042 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20043 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20044 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020045
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020046 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020047 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20048 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
20049 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
20050 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020051 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020052 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20053 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20054
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020055src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20056 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20057 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20058 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20059 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20060 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20061 was verified.
20062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020063src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020064 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020065 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020066 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020067 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020069src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020070 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020071 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20072 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020073 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020075src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20076 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
20077 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20078 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020079 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020080
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020081src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20082 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
20083 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20084 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20085 is an integer between 0 and 99.
20086 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
20087 is returned.
20088 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
20089 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20090 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
20091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020092src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020093 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020094 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020095 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020096 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020097
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020098src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20099 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20100 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20101 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20102 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
20103
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020104src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20105 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20106 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20107 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
20108 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20109 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
20110 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
20111
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020112src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20113 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20114 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20115 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20116 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
20117
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020118src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20119 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20120 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
20121 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20122 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
20123 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20124 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
20125 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20126 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20127 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20128 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020130src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020131 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020132 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020133 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20134 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020135 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20136 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20137 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020138
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020139src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20140 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20141 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20142 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20143 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20144 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20145 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20146 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020148src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020149 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020150 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020151 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020152 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020153 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020155src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20156 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
20157 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20158 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20159 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020160 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020161
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020162src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20163 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
20164 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050020165 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020166 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
20167 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20168
20169src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20170 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
20171 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20172 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
20173 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
20174 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
20175 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
20176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020177src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020178 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020179 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20180 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020181 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020183src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20184 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
20185 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20186 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020187 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020188 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020189
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020190src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20191 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
20192 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20193 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
20194 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20195 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
20196 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20197 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20198 See also sc_inc_gpc.
20199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020200src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20201 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20202 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20203 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020204 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020205 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20206 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020207
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020208 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020209 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020210 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020211 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020212
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020213src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20214 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20215 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20216 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
20217 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20218 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20219 connection when a first ACL was verified.
20220
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020221src_is_local : boolean
20222 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
20223 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
20224 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
20225 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020226 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020227 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
20228 once per connection.
20229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020230src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020231 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
20232 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20233 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
20234 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
20235 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020237src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020238 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
20239 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20240 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
20241 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
20242 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020244src_port : integer
20245 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020246 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
20247 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
20248 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
20249 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010020250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020251src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020252 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020253 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20254 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
20255 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020256 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020258src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20259 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
20260 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20261 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20262 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020263 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020265src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20266 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
20267 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
20268 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
20269 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
20270 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
20271 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
20272 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
20273 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020274
20275 Example :
20276 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
20277 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
20278 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
20279 listen ssh
20280 bind :22
20281 mode tcp
20282 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020283 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020284 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020285 server local 127.0.0.1:22
20286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020287srv_id : integer
20288 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
20289 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020290 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020020291
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020292srv_name : string
20293 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
20294 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020295 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020296
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200202977.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020298----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020020299
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020300The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020301closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
20302when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
20303usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020304future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020305
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00002030651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
20307 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
20308 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
20309 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
20310 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
20311 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
20312
20313 Example :
20314 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
20315 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
20316 # the request.
20317 frontend http-in
20318 bind *:8081
20319 default_backend servers
20320 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
20321 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
20322
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020323ssl_bc : boolean
20324 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20325 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020326 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20327 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020328
20329ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
20330 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020331 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20332 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020333
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020334ssl_bc_alpn : string
20335 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
20336 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020337 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020338 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20339 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20340 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
20341 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
20342 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020343 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
20344 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020345
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020346ssl_bc_cipher : string
20347 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020348 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20349 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020350
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020351ssl_bc_client_random : binary
20352 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20353 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20354 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020355 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020356
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020357ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020358 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020359 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20360 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
20361 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
20362 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020363 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
20364 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
20365 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
20366
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020367ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020368 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020369 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20370 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
20371 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020372
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020373ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
20374 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20375 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020376 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20377 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020378
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020379ssl_bc_npn : string
20380 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
20381 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020382 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020383 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
20384 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
20385 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
20386 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020387 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
20388 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020389
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020390ssl_bc_protocol : string
20391 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020392 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20393 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020394
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020395ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020396 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020397 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020398 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
20399 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020400
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020401ssl_bc_server_random : binary
20402 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20403 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20404 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020405 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020406
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020407ssl_bc_session_id : binary
20408 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
20409 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020410 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20411 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020412
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020413ssl_bc_session_key : binary
20414 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
20415 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20416 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020417 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020418
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020419ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
20420 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020421 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20422 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020424ssl_c_ca_err : integer
20425 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20426 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
20427 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
20428 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
20429 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020431ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
20432 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20433 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
20434 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
20435 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020436
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020437ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020438 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
20439 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20440 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020441 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020442 does not support resumed sessions.
20443
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020444ssl_c_der : binary
20445 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
20446 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20447 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020449ssl_c_err : integer
20450 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20451 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
20452 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
20453 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20454 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020455
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020456ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020457 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20458 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20459 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20460 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20461 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20462 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20463 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20464 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020465 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20466 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20467 LDAP v3.
20468 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20469 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020471ssl_c_key_alg : string
20472 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20473 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20474 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020476ssl_c_notafter : string
20477 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
20478 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20479 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020020480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020481ssl_c_notbefore : string
20482 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
20483 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20484 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020485
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020486ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020487 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20488 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20489 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20490 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20491 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20492 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20493 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20494 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020495 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20496 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20497 LDAP v3.
20498 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20499 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020501ssl_c_serial : binary
20502 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
20503 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20504 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020506ssl_c_sha1 : binary
20507 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
20508 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
20509 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020510 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
20511 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
20512
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020513 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020514 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020516ssl_c_sig_alg : string
20517 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20518 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20519 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020521ssl_c_used : boolean
20522 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
20523 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020525ssl_c_verify : integer
20526 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
20527 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
20528 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
20529 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020531ssl_c_version : integer
20532 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
20533 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020534
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010020535ssl_f_der : binary
20536 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
20537 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20538 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20539
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020540ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020541 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20542 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20543 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20544 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020545 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020546 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20547 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20548 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020549 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20550 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20551 LDAP v3.
20552 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20553 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020555ssl_f_key_alg : string
20556 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20557 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
20558 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020560ssl_f_notafter : string
20561 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20562 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20563 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020565ssl_f_notbefore : string
20566 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20567 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20568 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020569
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020570ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020571 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20572 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20573 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20574 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20575 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20576 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20577 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20578 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020579 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20580 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20581 LDAP v3.
20582 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20583 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020585ssl_f_serial : binary
20586 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20587 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20588 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020589
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020020590ssl_f_sha1 : binary
20591 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
20592 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20593 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020595ssl_f_sig_alg : string
20596 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20597 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20598 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020599
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020600ssl_f_version : integer
20601 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20602 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20603
20604ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020605 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20606 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
20607 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
20608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020609 Example :
20610 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
20611 listen http-https
20612 bind :80
20613 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
20614 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
20615
20616ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
20617 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
20618 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20619
20620ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020621 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020622 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020623 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020624 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20625 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20626 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
20627 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
20628 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
20629 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
20630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020631ssl_fc_cipher : string
20632 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
20633 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020020634
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020635ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20636 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
20637 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020638 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020639 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20640 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20641 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020642
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020643 Example:
20644 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20645 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20646 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20647 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20648 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20649 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20650 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20651 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20652 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20653
20654ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020655 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020656 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020657 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
20658 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020659 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20660 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020661
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020662ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020663 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020664 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020665 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020666 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20667 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20668 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20669 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
20670 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
20671 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020672
20673ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020674 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020675 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
20676 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020677
20678ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
20679 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
20680 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020681 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020682
20683 Example:
20684 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20685 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20686 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20687 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20688 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20689 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20690 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20691 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20692 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20693
20694ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20695 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
20696 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020697 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020698 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20699 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
20700 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20701
20702 Example:
20703 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20704 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20705 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20706 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20707 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20708 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20709 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20710 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20711 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20712
20713ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20714 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
20715 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020716 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020717 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20718 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
20719 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20720
20721 Example:
20722 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20723 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20724 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20725 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20726 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20727 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20728 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20729 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20730 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020731
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020732ssl_fc_client_random : binary
20733 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20734 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20735 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20736
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020737ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
20738 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20739 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20740 transport layer.
20741 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20742 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20743 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20744 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20745
20746ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20747 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20748 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20749 transport layer.
20750 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20751 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20752 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20753 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20754
20755ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
20756 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20757 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20758 transport layer.
20759 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20760 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20761 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20762 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20763
20764ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
20765 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20766 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20767 transport layer.
20768 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20769 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20770 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20771 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20772
20773ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
20774 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20775 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20776 transport layer.
20777 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20778 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20779 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20780 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20781
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020782ssl_fc_err : integer
20783 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20784 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20785 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
20786 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
20787 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
20788 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
20789 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
20790 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
20791 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
20792 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
20793 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
20794 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20795 codes.
20796
20797ssl_fc_err_str : string
20798 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20799 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20800 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
20801 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
20802 also "ssl_fc_err".
20803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020804ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020805 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
20806 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010020807 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
20808 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
20809 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
20810 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020811
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020020812ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
20813 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
20814 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
20815 wait until the handshake happened.
20816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020817ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
20818 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020819 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
20820 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020821 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020822 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020823
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020020824ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020825 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010020826 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
20827 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020829ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020830 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020831 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020832 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
20833 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
20834 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
20835 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
20836 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
20837 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020020838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020839ssl_fc_protocol : string
20840 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
20841 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020842
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020843ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
20844 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
20845 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020846 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
20847 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020848
20849 Example:
20850 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20851 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20852 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20853 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20854 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20855 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20856 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20857 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20858 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20859
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020860ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020861 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020862 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010020863 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020864
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020865ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20866 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20867 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20868 transport layer.
20869 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20870 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20871 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20872 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20873
20874ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
20875 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20876 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20877 transport layer.
20878 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20879 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20880 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20881 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20882
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020883ssl_fc_server_random : binary
20884 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20885 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20886 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020888ssl_fc_session_id : binary
20889 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
20890 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
20891 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
20892 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020893
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020894ssl_fc_session_key : binary
20895 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
20896 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20897 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
20898 BoringSSL.
20899
20900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020901ssl_fc_sni : string
20902 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
20903 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020904 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020905 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
20906 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
20907
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020908 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020909 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020910 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020911 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020020912 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020913
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010020914 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
20915 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
20916 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
20917 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
20918 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
20919 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
20920 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
20921 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
20922 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
20923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020924 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020925 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
20926 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020020927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020928ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
20929 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
20930 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020931
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020932ssl_s_der : binary
20933 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
20934 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20935 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20936
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020937ssl_s_chain_der : binary
20938 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
20939 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20940 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020941 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020942 does not support resumed sessions.
20943
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020944ssl_s_key_alg : string
20945 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20946 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
20947 SSL/TLS transport layer.
20948
20949ssl_s_notafter : string
20950 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
20951 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20952 transport layer.
20953
20954ssl_s_notbefore : string
20955 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
20956 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20957 transport layer.
20958
20959ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20960 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20961 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20962 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20963 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20964 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20965 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020966 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20967 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020968 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20969 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20970 LDAP v3.
20971 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20972 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20973
20974ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20975 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20976 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20977 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20978 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20979 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20980 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020981 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20982 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020983 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20984 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20985 LDAP v3.
20986 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20987 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20988
20989ssl_s_serial : binary
20990 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
20991 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20992 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20993
20994ssl_s_sha1 : binary
20995 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
20996 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20997 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20998
20999ssl_s_sig_alg : string
21000 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21001 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21002 layer.
21003
21004ssl_s_version : integer
21005 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
21006 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021007
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200210087.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021009------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021011Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
21012sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
21013only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
21014For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
21015be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
21016can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
21017sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
21018for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
21019content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021020
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021021Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
21022 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021023 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021024 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
21025 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
21026 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
21027 sample expression). So be careful.
21028
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010021029distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
21030 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
21031 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
21032 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
21033 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
21034 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
21035 list of supported tokens.
21036
21037distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
21038 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
21039 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
21040 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
21041 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
21042 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
21043 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
21044 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
21045 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
21046 supported tokens.
21047
21048 Example :
21049 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
21050 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
21051 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
21052 # send large files to the big farm
21053 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
21054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021055payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021056 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021057 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
21058 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021060payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
21061 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021062 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021063 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021065req.len : integer
21066req_len : integer (deprecated)
21067 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21068 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21069 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21070 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21071 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021072 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021073 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
21074 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021076req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21077 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021078 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
21079 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
21080 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
21081 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021082
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021083 ACL derivatives :
21084 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021086req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21087 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21088 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21089 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
21090 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021091
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021092 ACL derivatives :
21093 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021095 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021096
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021097req.proto_http : boolean
21098req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
21099 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
21100 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
21101 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
21102 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
21103 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
21104 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
21105 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021107 Example:
21108 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
21109 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21110 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020021111 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021113req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
21114rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21115 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
21116 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
21117 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
21118 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
21119 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
21120 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
21121 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021123 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
21124 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
21125 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
21126 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
21127 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
21128 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021130 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021131 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021133 Example :
21134 listen tse-farm
21135 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
21136 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
21137 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
21138 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
21139 # apply RDP cookie persistence
21140 persist rdp-cookie
21141 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
21142 # This is only useful makes sense if
21143 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
21144 stick-table type string size 204800
21145 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
21146 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
21147 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021149 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021150 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021152req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
21153rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
21154 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
21155 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
21156 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
21157 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021159 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021160 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021161
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021162req.ssl_alpn : string
21163 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
21164 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
21165 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
21166 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
21167 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
21168 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021169 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021170
21171 Examples :
21172 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21173 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021174 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021175 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021176 default_backend bk_default
21177
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021178req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
21179 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
21180 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020021181 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
21182 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
21183 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
21184 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
21185 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021187req.ssl_hello_type : integer
21188req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21189 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21190 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
21191 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21192 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21193 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
21194 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21195 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021197req.ssl_sni : string
21198req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
21199 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
21200 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
21201 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
21202 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21203 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020021204 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
21205 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
21206 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
21207 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
21208 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
21209 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
21210 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
21211 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
21212 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021214 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021215 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021217 Examples :
21218 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21219 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021220 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021221 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021222 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021223
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053021224req.ssl_st_ext : integer
21225 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
21226 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
21227 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
21228 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
21229 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
21230 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
21231 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
21232 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
21233 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
21234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021235req.ssl_ver : integer
21236req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
21237 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
21238 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
21239 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
21240 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
21241 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21242 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
21243 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021244 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021245 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021247 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021248 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021249
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021250res.len : integer
21251 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21252 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21253 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21254 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21255 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021256 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021257 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021258 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021260res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21261 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021262 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021263 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021264 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021265 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021267res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21268 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21269 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21270 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021271 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
21272 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021274 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021275
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020021276res.ssl_hello_type : integer
21277rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21278 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21279 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
21280 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21281 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21282 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
21283 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21284 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
21285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021286wait_end : boolean
21287 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
21288 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021289 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021290 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
21291 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021292 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021293 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
21294 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021296 Examples :
21297 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
21298 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
21299 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021301 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
21302 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21303 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
21304 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
21305 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
21306 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
21307 tcp-request content reject
21308
21309
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200213107.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021311--------------------------------------
21312
21313It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
21314This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
21315data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
21316its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
21317HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
21318content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
21319to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
21320more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
21321response are indexed.
21322
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010021323Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
21324 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
21325 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
21326 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
21327 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
21328 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
21329 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
21330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021331base : string
21332 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21333 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
21334 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
21335 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
21336 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
21337 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
21338 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
21339 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
21340
21341 ACL derivatives :
21342 base : exact string match
21343 base_beg : prefix match
21344 base_dir : subdir match
21345 base_dom : domain match
21346 base_end : suffix match
21347 base_len : length match
21348 base_reg : regex match
21349 base_sub : substring match
21350
21351base32 : integer
21352 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
21353 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
21354 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020021355 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
21356 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
21357 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021358
21359base32+src : binary
21360 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
21361 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
21362 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
21363 per-URL counters.
21364
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010021365baseq : string
21366 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21367 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
21368 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
21369 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
21370
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021371capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
21372 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
21373 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21374 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
21375
21376capture.req.method : string
21377 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
21378 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
21379 because it's allocated.
21380
21381capture.req.uri : string
21382 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
21383 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
21384 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
21385 allocated.
21386
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021387capture.req.ver : string
21388 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21389 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
21390 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
21391
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021392capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
21393 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
21394 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21395 The first entry is an index of 0.
21396 See also: "capture response header"
21397
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021398capture.res.ver : string
21399 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21400 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
21401 persistent flag.
21402
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021403req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021404 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
21405 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
21406 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021407
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021408req.body_param([<name>[,i]]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021409 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
21410 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
21411 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
21412 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021413 case-sensitive, unless "i" is added as a second argument. If no name is
21414 given, any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The
21415 result is a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as
21416 presented in the request body (no URL decoding is performed). Note that the
21417 ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will
21418 iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given.
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021419
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021420req.body_len : integer
21421 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
21422 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021423 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
21424 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021425
21426req.body_size : integer
21427 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021428 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21429 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021431req.cook([<name>]) : string
21432cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21433 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21434 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
21435 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
21436 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
21437 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
21438 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
21439 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
21440 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
21441
21442 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021443 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
21444 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
21445 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
21446 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
21447 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
21448 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
21449 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
21450 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021452req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21453cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21454 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21455 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021457req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21458cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21459 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21460 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
21461 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
21462 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021464cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21465 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21466 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
21467 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
21468 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021469 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021470 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
21471 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
21472 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
21473 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021475hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21476 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
21477 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
21478 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
21479 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021480 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021482req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021483 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
21484 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
21485 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
21486 with headers such as User-Agent.
21487
21488 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21489 found.
21490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021491 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21492 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21493 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021494 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021496req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21497 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21498 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021499 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
21500 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021502req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021503 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
21504 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
21505 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
21506 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
21507 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
21508 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
21509 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
21510
21511 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21512 found.
21513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021514 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21515 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21516 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021517 with -1 being the last one.
21518
21519 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
21520 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021522 ACL derivatives :
21523 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21524 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21525 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21526 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21527 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21528 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21529 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21530 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
21531
21532req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21533hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
21534 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21535 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021536 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
21537 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
21538 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
21539
21540 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
21541 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
21542 which contain more than one of certain headers.
21543
21544 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021545
21546req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21547hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
21548 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
21549 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
21550 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010021551 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
21552 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
21553 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
21554 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
21555 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021556
21557 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21558
21559 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021560
21561req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21562hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
21563 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
21564 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
21565 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021566
21567 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21568
21569 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021570
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021571req.hdrs : string
21572 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
21573 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21574 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
21575 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21576
21577req.hdrs_bin : binary
21578 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21579 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
21580 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
21581 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
21582 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
21583 names and values (length of 0 for both).
21584
21585 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021586
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021587 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21588 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021590http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
21591 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
21592 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
21593 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21594 basic auth is supported.
21595
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020021596http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
21597 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
21598 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
21599 performed on the data sent by the client.
21600 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
21601 Authorization one.
21602
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021603http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
21604 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
21605 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
21606 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
21607 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021608 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21609 basic auth is supported.
21610
21611 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021612 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
21613 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
21614 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
21615 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021616
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021617http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021618 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
21619 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21620 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021621
21622http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021623 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
21624 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21625 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021626
21627http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021628 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
21629 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
21630 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021632http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021633 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
21634 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021635 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
21636 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021638method : integer + string
21639 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
21640 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
21641 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
21642 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
21643 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
21644 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
21645 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021647 ACL derivatives :
21648 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021650 Example :
21651 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
21652 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
21653 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021655path : string
21656 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
21657 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
21658 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
21659 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
21660 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021661 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021662 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021664 ACL derivatives :
21665 path : exact string match
21666 path_beg : prefix match
21667 path_dir : subdir match
21668 path_dom : domain match
21669 path_end : suffix match
21670 path_len : length match
21671 path_reg : regex match
21672 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021673
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020021674pathq : string
21675 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
21676 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
21677 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
21678 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
21679 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
21680 result in both cases.
21681
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021682query : string
21683 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
21684 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
21685 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
21686 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021687 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021688 which stops before the question mark.
21689
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021690req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21691 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21692 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21693 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
21694 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021696req.ver : string
21697req_ver : string (deprecated)
21698 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
21699 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
21700 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021702 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021703 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021704
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021705res.body : binary
21706 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
21707 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021708 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21709
21710 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021711
21712res.body_len : integer
21713 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
21714 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021715 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21716
21717 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021718
21719res.body_size : integer
21720 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
21721 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21722 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
21723 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021724 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21725
21726 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021727
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010021728res.cache_hit : boolean
21729 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
21730 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
21731
21732res.cache_name : string
21733 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
21734 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
21735 empty string.
21736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021737res.comp : boolean
21738 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
21739 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
21740 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021742res.comp_algo : string
21743 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
21744 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
21745 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021747res.cook([<name>]) : string
21748scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21749 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21750 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021751 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21752
21753 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021755 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021756 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021758res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21759scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21760 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21761 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021762 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
21763
21764 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021766res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21767scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21768 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21769 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021770 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21771
21772 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021774res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021775 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21776 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21777
21778 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
21779 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
21780
21781 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
21782
21783 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021785res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021786 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21787 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21788
21789 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
21790 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
21791
21792 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021794res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21795shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021796 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21797 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21798
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021799 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021800 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
21801
21802 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021804 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021805 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21806 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21807 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21808 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21809 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21810 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21811 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21812 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021813
21814res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21815shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021816 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21817 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21818
21819 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021820 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021821
21822 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021824res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21825shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021826 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
21827 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21828
21829 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21830
21831 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021832
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021833res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21834 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21835 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21836 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021837 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21838
21839 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021841res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21842shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021843 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
21844 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21845
21846 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21847
21848 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021849
21850res.hdrs : string
21851 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
21852 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21853 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021854 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21855
21856 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021857
21858res.hdrs_bin : binary
21859 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21860 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
21861 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
21862 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
21863 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
21864 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
21865 (length of 0 for both).
21866
21867 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
21868
21869 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21870 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021872res.ver : string
21873resp_ver : string (deprecated)
21874 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021875 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
21876
21877 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021878
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021879 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021880 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021882set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21883 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21884 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021885 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021886 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021888 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
21889 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021891status : integer
21892 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
21893 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021894 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
21895
21896 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021897
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020021898unique-id : string
21899 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
21900 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
21901 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
21902 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
21903 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
21904 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
21905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021906url : string
21907 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
21908 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
21909 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
21910 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
21911 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
21912 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
21913 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021915 ACL derivatives :
21916 url : exact string match
21917 url_beg : prefix match
21918 url_dir : subdir match
21919 url_dom : domain match
21920 url_end : suffix match
21921 url_len : length match
21922 url_reg : regex match
21923 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021925url_ip : ip
21926 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
21927 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
21928 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
21929 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021930 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
21931 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021932
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021933url_port : integer
21934 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021935 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021936
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021937urlp([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
21938url_param([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021939 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
21940 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021941 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive, unless"i" is added as a
21942 third argument. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
21943 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
21944 parameter <name> as presented in the request (no URL decoding is performed).
21945 This can be used for session stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an
21946 application cookie passed as a URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks.
21947 Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and
21948 will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021950 ACL derivatives :
21951 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
21952 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
21953 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
21954 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
21955 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
21956 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
21957 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
21958 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021959
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021961 Example :
21962 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
21963 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
21964 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
21965 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021966
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021967urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021968 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
21969 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
21970 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020021971
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020021972url32 : integer
21973 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
21974 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
21975 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
21976 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
21977 is an unsigned integer.
21978
21979url32+src : binary
21980 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
21981 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
21982 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
21983
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020021984
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200219857.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021986---------------------------------------
21987
21988This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
21989used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
21990purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
21991There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
21992or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
21993any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
21994for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
21995
21996internal.htx.data : integer
21997 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
21998 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21999
22000internal.htx.free : integer
22001 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
22002 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22003
22004internal.htx.free_data : integer
22005 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
22006 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22007
22008internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010022009 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
22010 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
22011 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022012
22013internal.htx.nbblks : integer
22014 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
22015 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22016
22017internal.htx.size : integer
22018 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
22019 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22020
22021internal.htx.used : integer
22022 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
22023 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22024 direction.
22025
22026internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
22027 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22028 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
22029 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
22030 of the special value :
22031 * head : The oldest inserted block
22032 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022033 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022034
22035internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
22036 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22037 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
22038 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
22039 integer or one of the special value :
22040 * head : The oldest inserted block
22041 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022042 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022043
22044internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
22045 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22046 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
22047 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22048 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22049
22050 * head : The oldest inserted block
22051 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022052 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022053
22054internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
22055 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22056 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22057 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22058 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22059
22060 * head : The oldest inserted block
22061 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022062 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022063
22064internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
22065 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22066 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22067 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22068 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22069
22070 * head : The oldest inserted block
22071 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022072 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022073
22074internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
22075 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
22076 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
22077 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22078 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22079
22080 * head : The oldest inserted block
22081 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022082 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022083
22084internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
22085 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
22086 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
22087 it returns false.
22088
22089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200220907.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022091---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022093Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
22094every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020022095order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022096
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022097ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022098---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
22099FALSE always_false never match
22100HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
22101HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
22102HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010022103HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022104HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
22105HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
22106HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
22107HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020022108LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022109METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
22110METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
22111METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
22112METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
22113METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
22114METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
22115METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
22116METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
22117RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
22118REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
22119TRUE always_true always match
22120WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
22121---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022122
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010022123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221248. Logging
22125----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022126
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022127One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
22128provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
22129very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
22130provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
22131state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022132to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022133headers.
22134
22135In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
22136about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
22137send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
22138
22139 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
22140 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
22141 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
22142 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
22143 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022144 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060022145 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022146
22147The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
22148allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
22149as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
22150while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
22151real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
22152delay.
22153
22154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221558.1. Log levels
22156---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022157
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022158TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022159source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022160HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
22161in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
22162track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
22163syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
22164about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022165
22166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221678.2. Log formats
22168----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022169
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022170HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022171and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
22172slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
22173options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022174
22175 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
22176 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
22177 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
22178 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
22179 extents.
22180
22181 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
22182 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
22183 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
22184 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
22185 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
22186
22187 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
22188 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
22189 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
22190 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
22191 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
22192
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020022193 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
22194 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
22195 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
22196 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
22197
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022198 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
22199
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022200Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
22201specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
22202field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
22203servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
22204always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
22205identifier.
22206
22207Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
22208 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
22209 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
22210 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
22211 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
22212
22213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222148.2.1. Default log format
22215-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022216
22217This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
22218as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
22219format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
22220
22221 Example :
22222 listen www
22223 mode http
22224 log global
22225 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22226
22227 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
22228 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
22229 (www/HTTP)
22230
22231 Field Format Extract from the example above
22232 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
22233 2 'Connect from' Connect from
22234 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
22235 4 'to' to
22236 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
22237 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
22238
22239Detailed fields description :
22240 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
22241 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
22242 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
22243 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
22244 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22245 and processed the connection.
22246 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
22247
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022248In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
22249"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
22250connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
22251
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022252It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
22253will eventually disappear.
22254
22255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222568.2.2. TCP log format
22257---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022258
22259The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
22260is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
22261information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
22262counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
22263emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
22264environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
22265the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
22266sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022267specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022268not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22269
22270The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22271exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022272if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
22273Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022274
22275 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
22276 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
22277 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022278 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
22279 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022280
22281A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
22282are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022283
22284 Example :
22285 frontend fnt
22286 mode tcp
22287 option tcplog
22288 log global
22289 default_backend bck
22290
22291 backend bck
22292 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22293
22294 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
22295 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
22296 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
22297
22298 Field Format Extract from the example above
22299 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
22300 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
22301 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
22302 4 frontend_name fnt
22303 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
22304 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
22305 7 bytes_read* 212
22306 8 termination_state --
22307 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
22308 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22309
22310Detailed fields description :
22311 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022312 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022313 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22314 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022315 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022316 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022317 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022318
22319 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022320 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22321 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22322 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022323
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022324 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022325 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
22326 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022327 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
22328 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
22329 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
22330 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022331
22332 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22333 and processed the connection.
22334
22335 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22336 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22337 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
22338 applications.
22339
22340 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22341 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22342 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22343 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
22344 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
22345
22346 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22347 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
22348 See "Timers" below for more details.
22349
22350 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22351 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
22352 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
22353 "Timers" below for more details.
22354
22355 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022356 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022357 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
22358 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
22359 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
22360 details.
22361
22362 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
22363 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
22364 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
22365 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
22366 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
22367
22368 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22369 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22370 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
22371 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
22372 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
22373 for more details.
22374
22375 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022376 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022377 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
22378 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
22379 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022380 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022381
22382 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22383 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22384 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22385 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22386 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22387 caused by a denial of service attack.
22388
22389 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22390 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22391 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22392 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22393 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22394 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22395 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22396 denial of service attack.
22397
22398 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22399 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22400 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22401 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22402 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22403 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22404 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22405 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
22406 be processed than on other servers.
22407
22408 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22409 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22410 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22411 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022412 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022413 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22414 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22415 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22416 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22417 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22418 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22419 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22420 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22421
22422 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22423 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22424 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22425 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22426 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22427 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022428 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022429 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22430
22431 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22432 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22433 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22434 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22435 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22436 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022437 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022438 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22439 occurs.
22440
22441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200224428.2.3. HTTP log format
22443----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022444
22445The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
22446is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
22447the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
22448are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
22449emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
22450generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
22451"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
22452which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022453frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
22454is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022455
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022456The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22457exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022458if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22459instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022460
22461 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
22462 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22463 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
22464
22465And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
22466this exact string:
22467
22468 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
22469 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
22470 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
22471 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022472 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
22473 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022474
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022475Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
22476slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
22477with a star ('*') after the field name below.
22478
22479 Example :
22480 frontend http-in
22481 mode http
22482 option httplog
22483 log global
22484 default_backend bck
22485
22486 backend static
22487 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22488
22489 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22490 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
22491 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022492 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022493
22494 Field Format Extract from the example above
22495 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22496 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022497 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022498 4 frontend_name http-in
22499 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022500 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022501 7 status_code 200
22502 8 bytes_read* 2750
22503 9 captured_request_cookie -
22504 10 captured_response_cookie -
22505 11 termination_state ----
22506 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22507 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22508 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22509 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22510 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022511
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022512Detailed fields description :
22513 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022514 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022515 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22516 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022517 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022518 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022519 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022520
22521 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022522 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22523 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22524 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022525
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022526 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022527 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022528
22529 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22530 and processed the connection.
22531
22532 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22533 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22534 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
22535
22536 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22537 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22538 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22539 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
22540 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
22541 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
22542
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022543 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
22544 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
22545 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022546 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022547 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
22548 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022549 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022550 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022551
22552 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22553 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022554 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022555
22556 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22557 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022558 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
22559 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022560
22561 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
22562 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
22563 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
22564 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
22565 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022566 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
22567 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022568
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022569 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022570 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
22571 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
22572 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
22573 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
22574 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
22575 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022576 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022577
22578 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022579 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
22580 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022581
22582 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
22583 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022584 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022585 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
22586 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
22587 overflowing.
22588
22589 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
22590 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
22591 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
22592 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
22593 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
22594 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
22595 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
22596 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22597
22598 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
22599 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
22600 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
22601 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
22602 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
22603 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
22604 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
22605 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22606
22607 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22608 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22609 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
22610 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
22611 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
22612 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
22613 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
22614
22615 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022616 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022617 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
22618 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
22619 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022620 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022621 system.
22622
22623 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22624 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22625 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22626 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22627 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22628 caused by a denial of service attack.
22629
22630 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22631 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22632 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22633 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22634 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22635 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22636 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22637 denial of service attack.
22638
22639 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22640 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22641 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22642 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22643 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22644 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22645 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22646 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
22647 processed than on other servers.
22648
22649 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22650 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22651 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22652 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022653 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022654 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22655 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22656 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22657 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22658 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22659 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22660 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22661 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22662
22663 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22664 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22665 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22666 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22667 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22668 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022669 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022670 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22671
22672 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22673 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22674 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22675 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22676 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22677 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022678 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022679 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22680 occurs.
22681
22682 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
22683 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
22684 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
22685 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
22686 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
22687 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
22688 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
22689 cookies" below for more details.
22690
22691 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
22692 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
22693 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
22694 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
22695 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
22696 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
22697 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
22698 and cookies" below for more details.
22699
22700 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
22701 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
22702 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
22703 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
22704 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
22705 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
22706 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
22707 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
22708
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022709
227108.2.4. HTTPS log format
22711----------------------
22712
22713The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
22714extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
22715information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
22716frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
22717end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
22718matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
22719sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
22720dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
22721"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22722
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022723The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22724exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022725if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22726instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022727
22728 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
22729 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22730 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
22731 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022732 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022733 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
22734 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022735
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022736This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
22737appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
22738HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022739
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022740 Example :
22741 frontend https-in
22742 mode http
22743 option httpslog
22744 log global
22745 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
22746 default_backend bck
22747
22748 backend static
22749 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
22750
22751 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22752 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
22753 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022754 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
22755 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022756
22757 Field Format Extract from the example above
22758 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22759 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
22760 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
22761 4 frontend_name https-in
22762 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
22763 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
22764 7 status_code 200
22765 8 bytes_read* 2750
22766 9 captured_request_cookie -
22767 10 captured_response_cookie -
22768 11 termination_state ----
22769 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22770 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22771 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22772 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22773 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022774 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022775 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022776 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
22777 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022778
22779Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022780 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
22781 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
22782 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022783
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022784 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
22785 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
22786 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050022787 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022788 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022789
22790 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
22791 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
22792 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
22793 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
22794
22795 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
22796 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
22797 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
22798 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
22799
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022800 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
22801 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
22802 can be shared by multiple requests.
22803
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022804 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
22805 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
22806 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
22807 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
22808 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
22809
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022810 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
22811
22812 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
22813
22814
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100228158.2.5. Error log format
22816-----------------------
22817
22818When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
22819protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
22820unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
22821line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
22822"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
22823will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
22824logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
22825
22826The default format looks like this :
22827
22828 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
22829 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
22830 Connection error during SSL handshake
22831
22832 Field Format Extract from the example above
22833 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
22834 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
22835 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
22836 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
22837 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
22838
22839These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
22840failures.
22841
22842By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
22843above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
22844defined format.
22845
22846An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
22847source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
22848number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
22849internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
22850error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
22851the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
22852certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
22853indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
22854indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
22855ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
22856are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
22857would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
22858regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
22859
22860 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010022861 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010022862 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
22863 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
22864
22865
228668.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022867------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022868
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022869When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
22870ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
22871a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
22872formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
22873looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
22874and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022875
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022876HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022877Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
22878separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
22879prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
22880
22881Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
22882variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022883("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022884
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022885If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020022886as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022887less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
22888the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
22889
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020022890Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
22891"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
22892delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
22893preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022894
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022895Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
22896'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
22897https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
22898such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
22899
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022900Flags are :
22901 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022902 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022903 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
22904 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022905
22906 Example:
22907
22908 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
22909 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
22910
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022911 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
22912
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022913Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
22914
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022915 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022916 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022917 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
22918 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
22919 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022920 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
22921 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
22922 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022923 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022924 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000022925 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000022926 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000022927 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022928 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
22929 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010022930 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020022931 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022932 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010022933 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022934 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020022935 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080022936 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022937 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
22938 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
22939 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
22940 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
22941 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022942 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022943 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022944 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022945 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022946 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022947 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
22948 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022949 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22950 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
22951 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022952 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022953 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
22954 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022955 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022956 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22957 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
22958 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020022959 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020022960 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022961 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
22962 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
22963 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
22964 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020022965 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022966 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022967 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022968 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010022969 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022970 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022971 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
22972 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
22973 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022974 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022975 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
22976 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022977 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022978 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
22979 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020022980 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022981 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022982 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022983 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022984
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022985 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022986
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010022987
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200229888.3. Advanced logging options
22989-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022990
22991Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
22992just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
22993options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
22994for more information about their usage.
22995
22996
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200229978.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
22998------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022999
23000It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023001HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023002commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
23003monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
23004ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
23005
23006 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
23007 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
23008 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
23009 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
23010
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020023011 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
23012 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023013
23014 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
23015 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
23016 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
23017
23018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230198.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
23020----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023021
23022The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
23023what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
23024or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023025"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023026just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
23027log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
23028after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
23029is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
23030with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
23031with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
23032
23033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230348.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
23035------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023036
23037Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
23038for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
23039"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
23040retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
23041raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
23042a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
23043file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
23044you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
23045"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
23046
23047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230488.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
23049--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023050
23051Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
23052multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
23053them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
23054"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
23055logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
23056error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
23057and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
23058too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
23059useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
23060alternative.
23061
23062
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230638.4. Timing events
23064------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023065
23066Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
23067reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
23068the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
23069frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023070mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
23071addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
23072
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023073Timings events in HTTP mode:
23074
23075 first request 2nd request
23076 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
23077 t tr t tr ...
23078 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
23079 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
23080 :<---- Tq ---->: :
23081 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023082 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023083 :<--------- Ta --------->:
23084
23085Timings events in TCP mode:
23086
23087 TCP session
23088 |<----------------->|
23089 t t
23090 ---|----|----|----|----|---
23091 | Th Tw Tc Td |
23092 |<------ Tt ------->|
23093
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023094 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023095 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023096 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
23097 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
23098 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023099 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023100 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
23101 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
23102 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
23103 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023104
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023105 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
23106 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
23107 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023108 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
23109 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
23110 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
23111 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
23112 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
23113 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023114
23115 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
23116 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
23117 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
23118 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
23119 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
23120 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
23121 request typed by hand during a test.
23122
23123 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
23124 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023125 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023126 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
23127 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
23128 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
23129 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023130
23131 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
23132 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
23133 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
23134 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
23135 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
23136
23137 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
23138 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
23139 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
23140 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
23141 connection never established.
23142
23143 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
23144 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
23145 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
23146 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
23147 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
23148 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
23149 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
23150 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
23151 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
23152 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
23153 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
23154
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023155 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
23156 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
23157 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
23158 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
23159 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
23160 by subtracting other timers when valid :
23161
23162 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
23163
23164 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
23165 "Ta" can never be negative.
23166
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023167 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
23168 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023169 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
23170 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023171 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023172
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023173 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023174
23175 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023176 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
23177 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023178
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023179 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
23180 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
23181 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
23182 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
23183 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
23184 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
23185 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
23186 prefixed with a '+' sign.
23187
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023188These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
23189protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
23190that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023191due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
23192"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
23193that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023194
23195Most common cases :
23196
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023197 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
23198 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
23199 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
23200 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
23201 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023202 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023203 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
23204 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
23205 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
23206 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
23207 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020023208 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023209
23210 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
23211 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
23212 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
23213 of ms on remote networks.
23214
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023215 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
23216 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
23217 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023218
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023219 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
23220 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023221 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023222 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
23223 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
23224 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
23225 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
23226 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
23227 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023228
23229Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
23230
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023231 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023232 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023233 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023234
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023235 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023236 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
23237 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
23238
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023239 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023240 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
23241 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
23242 flags.
23243
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023244 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
23245 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023246 Check the session termination flags, then check the
23247 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
23248 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
23249 the client connection was maintained open.
23250
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023251 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023252 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023253 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023254 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
23255
23256
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232578.5. Session state at disconnection
23258-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023259
23260TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
23261"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
232622-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
23263each of which has a special meaning :
23264
23265 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
23266 session to terminate :
23267
23268 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
23269
23270 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
23271 server explicitly refused it.
23272
23273 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
23274 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
23275 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
23276 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023277 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023278
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023279 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023280 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023281
23282 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
23283 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
23284 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
23285 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
23286 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
23287
23288 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
23289 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
23290 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
23291 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
23292 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
23293
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023294 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090023295 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
23296
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023297 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070023298 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
23299 backup connections when going up.
23300
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023301 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020023302
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023303 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
23304 send or receive data.
23305
23306 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
23307 send or receive data.
23308
23309 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
23310 with nothing left in the buffers.
23311
23312 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
23313
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010023314 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023315 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
23316
23317 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
23318 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
23319 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
23320 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
23321 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
23322
23323 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
23324 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
23325
23326 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
23327 server (HTTP only).
23328
23329 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
23330
23331 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
23332 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
23333 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
23334
23335 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
23336 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
23337 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
23338
23339 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
23340
23341 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
23342 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
23343
23344 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
23345 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
23346 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
23347
23348 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
23349 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020023350 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
23351 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023352
23353 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
23354 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
23355 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
23356 another server.
23357
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023358 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023359 server.
23360
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023361 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
23362 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
23363 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
23364 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23365
23366 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
23367 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
23368 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
23369 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23370
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020023371 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
23372 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
23373 "use-server" rule).
23374
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023375 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23376
23377 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
23378 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
23379
23380 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
23381
23382 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
23383 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
23384 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
23385
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023386 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
23387 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023388 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023389 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
23390 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
23391
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023392 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
23393
23394 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
23395 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
23396
23397 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
23398
23399 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23400
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023401The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
23402was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023403helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
23404starvation, attacks, etc...
23405
23406The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
23407alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
23408easier finding and understanding.
23409
23410 Flags Reason
23411
23412 -- Normal termination.
23413
23414 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023415 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
23416 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023417 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
23418
23419 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
23420 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023421 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
23422 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023423 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
23424 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023425
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023426 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23427 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023428 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023429
23430 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
23431 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
23432 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
23433
23434 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
23435 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
23436 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
23437 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
23438 the server takes too long to respond.
23439
23440 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
23441 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
23442 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
23443 long a time to respond.
23444
23445 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
23446 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
23447 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023448 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023449 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
23450 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023451
23452 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
23453 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
23454 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
23455 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
23456 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020023457 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023458 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
23459 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
23460 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
23461 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
23462 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
23463 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
23464 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
23465 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023466 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023467 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
23468 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
23469 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023470
23471 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
23472 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023473 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
23474 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
23475 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
23476 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023477
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023478 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023479 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
23480
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023481 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023482 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
23483 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023484 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023485 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
23486 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
23487
23488 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
23489 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
23490 503 or 504 here.
23491
23492 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023493 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023494 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
23495 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
23496 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
23497
23498 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23499 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023500 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023501 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023502 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023503
23504 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
23505 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
23506 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
23507 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
23508 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
23509 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023510 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023511
23512 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
23513 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
23514 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
23515 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
23516 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
23517 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
23518 solution is to fix the application.
23519
23520 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
23521 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
23522 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
23523 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
23524 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
23525 external attacks.
23526
23527 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070023528 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023529 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023530 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
23531 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
23532
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023533 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
23534 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
23535 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023536 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020023537 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023538
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023539 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
23540 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
23541 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
23542 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023543 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
23544 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
23545 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
23546 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023547 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
23548 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
23549 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
23550 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023551
23552 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
23553 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
23554 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023555 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
23556 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
23557 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
23558 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023559
23560 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
23561 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
23562 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
23563 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
23564
23565 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
23566 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
23567 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
23568 only be solved by proper system tuning.
23569
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023570The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023571persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023572important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
23573re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
23574
23575 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
23576
23577 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23578 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
23579 set on a GET request.
23580
23581 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
23582 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023583 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023584 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
23585
23586 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
23587 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
23588 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
23589
23590 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23591 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
23592 already got a cookie.
23593
23594 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23595 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
23596 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
23597 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
23598 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
23599
23600 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23601 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23602 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23603
23604 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
23605 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23606 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23607
23608 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
23609 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
23610
23611 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
23612 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
23613 then advertised in the response.
23614
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023615
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236168.6. Non-printable characters
23617-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023618
23619In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
23620consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
23621converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
23622prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
23623being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
23624escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
23625is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
23626'}' when logging headers.
23627
23628Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
23629issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
23630containing spaces is "User-Agent".
23631
23632Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
23633the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
23634performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
23635
23636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236378.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
23638---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023639
23640Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
23641achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023642section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023643cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
23644the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
23645the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023646locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023647not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
23648user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
23649a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
23650wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
23651
23652 Examples :
23653 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
23654 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
23655
23656 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
23657 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
23658
23659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200236608.8. Capturing HTTP headers
23661---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023662
23663Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
23664proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
23665the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
23666server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
23667
23668Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
23669response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023670section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023671
23672It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023673time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
23674appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023675are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
23676and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
23677follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
23678request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
23679in the logs.
23680
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023681As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
23682frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
23683an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
23684
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023685 Example :
23686 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
23687 listen proxy-out
23688 mode http
23689 option httplog
23690 option logasap
23691 log global
23692 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
23693
23694 # log the name of the virtual server
23695 capture request header Host len 20
23696
23697 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
23698 capture request header Content-Length len 10
23699
23700 # log the beginning of the referrer
23701 capture request header Referer len 20
23702
23703 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
23704 capture response header Server len 20
23705
23706 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
23707 capture response header Content-Length len 10
23708
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023709 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023710 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
23711
23712 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
23713 capture response header Via len 20
23714
23715 # log the URL location during a redirection
23716 capture response header Location len 20
23717
23718 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
23719 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
23720 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23721 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
23722 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
23723
23724 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23725 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23726 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23727 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023728 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023729
23730 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23731 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23732 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23733 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
23734 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023735 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023736
23737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200237388.9. Examples of logs
23739---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023740
23741These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
23742them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
23743reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
23744
23745 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
23746 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23747 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23748
23749 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
23750 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
23751
23752 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
23753 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
23754 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23755
23756 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
23757 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
23758
23759 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
23760 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23761 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
23762
23763 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023764 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023765 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
23766 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
23767
23768 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
23769 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
23770 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
23771
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023772 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
23773 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
23774 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
23775 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023776 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023777 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023778
23779 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023780 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023781
23782 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
23783 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
23784 Nothing was sent to any server.
23785
23786 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
23787 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
23788
23789 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
23790 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023791 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023792 send a 408 return code to the client.
23793
23794 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
23795 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
23796
23797 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
23798 5 seconds ("c----").
23799
23800 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
23801 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023802 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023803
23804 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023805 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023806 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
23807 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
23808 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
23809 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
23810 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010023811
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020023812
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200238139. Supported filters
23814--------------------
23815
23816Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
23817accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
23818unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
23819
23820See also : "filter"
23821
238229.1. Trace
23823----------
23824
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010023825filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023826
23827 Arguments:
23828 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
23829 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
23830
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010023831 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023832
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023833 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023834 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
23835 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
23836 amount of the parsed data.
23837
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023838 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010023839
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023840This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
23841callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
23842information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
23843filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
23844
23845Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
23846tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
23847a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
23848
23849
238509.2. HTTP compression
23851---------------------
23852
23853filter compression
23854
23855The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
23856keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023857when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
23858fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
23859done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
23860explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
23861filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
23862listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23863order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023864
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023865See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
23866 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023867
23868
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200238699.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
23870--------------------------------------------
23871
23872filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
23873
23874 Arguments :
23875
23876 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
23877 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
23878 parsed.
23879
23880 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
23881 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
23882 part must be placed in its own scope.
23883
23884The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
23885external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023886streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023887exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
23888also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
23889
23890SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
23891the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
23892
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010023893For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023894"doc/SPOE.txt".
23895
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100238969.4. Cache
23897----------
23898
23899filter cache <name>
23900
23901 Arguments :
23902
23903 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
23904
23905The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
23906"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023907cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023908other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
23909case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
23910is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
23911filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010023912listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23913order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010023914
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023915See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
23916 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
23917
23918
239199.5. Fcgi-app
23920-------------
23921
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023922filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023923
23924 Arguments :
23925
23926 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
23927
23928The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
23929request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
23930reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
23931used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
23932implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
23933used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
23934fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
23935used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23936order.
23937
23938See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
23939 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
23940
23941
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100239429.6. OpenTracing
23943----------------
23944
23945The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
23946HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
23947of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
23948Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
23949
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023950This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023951
23952The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
23953HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
23954participates in the work of HAProxy.
23955
23956filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
23957
23958 Arguments :
23959
23960 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
23961 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
23962 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
23963 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
23964 OpenTracing filters.
23965
23966 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
23967 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
23968 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
23969 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
23970 filter must have its own scope defined.
23971
23972More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020023973of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023974
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200239759.7. Bandwidth limitation
23976--------------------------
23977
23978filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23979filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23980filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23981filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23982
23983 Arguments :
23984
23985 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
23986 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
23987
23988 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
23989 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23990 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23991 expressed in bytes.
23992
23993 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
23994 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
23995 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
23996 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23997
23998 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
23999 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
24000 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24001
24002 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024003 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024004 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
24005 is expressed in milliseconds.
24006
24007 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
24008 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
24009 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24010 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24011 expressed in bytes.
24012
24013Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
24014speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
24015bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
24016used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
24017sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
24018other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
24019connections for a given client.
24020
24021The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
24022filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
24023definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
24024the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
24025compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
24026the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
24027for the cache filter.
24028
24029There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
24030default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050024031to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024032the table.
24033
24034In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
24035limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
24036forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
24037the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
24038used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
24039cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
24040level.
24041
24042The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
24043connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
24044of the same connection may have different limits.
24045
24046For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
24047defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
24048bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
24049only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
24050when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
24051
24052For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
24053incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
24054corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24055stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24056used to limit outgoing data.
24057
24058Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
24059limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
24060to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
24061carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
24062it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
24063limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
24064experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
24065a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
24066start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
24067some experimentations.
24068
24069 Example:
24070 frontend http
24071 bind *:80
24072 mode http
24073
24074 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
24075 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
24076 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
24077
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024078 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024079 # independently of all other streams.
24080 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
24081
24082 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
24083 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
24084 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
24085 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
24086 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
24087 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
24088 ...
24089
24090 backend limit-by-src
24091 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
24092 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
24093
24094See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
24095 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
24096 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
24097 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024098
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002409910. FastCGI applications
24100-------------------------
24101
24102HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
24103feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
24104the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
24105FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
24106servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
24107FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
24108backend.
24109
24110HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
24111application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
24112connection.
24113
2411410.1. Setup
24115-----------
24116
2411710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
24118--------------------------
24119
24120fcgi-app <name>
24121 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
24122 document root must be defined.
24123
24124acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
24125 Declare or complete an access list.
24126
24127 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
24128 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
24129 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
24130 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
24131 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
24132
24133docroot <path>
24134 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
24135 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
24136 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
24137
24138index <script-name>
24139 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
24140 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
24141 is an optional setting.
24142
24143 Example :
24144 index index.php
24145
24146log-stderr global
24147log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010024148 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024149 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
24150
24151 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
24152 default STDERR messages are ignored.
24153
24154pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24155 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
24156 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
24157 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24158
24159 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
24160 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
24161 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
24162 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
24163
24164 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
24165 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
24166
24167path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024168 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024169 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
24170 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
24171 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
24172 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
24173 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
24174 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
24175 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024176
24177 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024178 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024179 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
24180 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
24181 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
24182 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024183
24184 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024185 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
24186 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024187
24188option get-values
24189no option get-values
24190 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
24191
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024192 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024193 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
24194
24195 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
24196 application will accept.
24197
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020024198 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
24199 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024200
24201 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050024202 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024203 option is disabled.
24204
24205 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
24206 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
24207 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
24208 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
24209 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
24210 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
24211
24212option keep-conn
24213no option keep-conn
24214 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
24215 sending a response.
24216
24217 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
24218 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
24219
24220option max-reqs <reqs>
24221 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
24222 accept.
24223
24224 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
24225 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
24226 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
24227 to 1.
24228
24229option mpxs-conns
24230no option mpxs-conns
24231 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
24232
24233 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
24234 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
24235
24236set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24237 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
24238 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
24239 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
24240 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24241
24242 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
24243 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
24244 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
24245
24246 Example :
24247 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
24248 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
24249
24250 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
24251
24252
2425310.1.2. Proxy section
24254---------------------
24255
24256use-fcgi-app <name>
24257 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
24258
24259 Arguments :
24260 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
24261
24262 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
24263 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
24264 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
24265 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
24266 application may be defined at a time per backend.
24267
24268 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
24269 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
24270 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
24271 application are evaluated.
24272
24273
2427410.1.3. Example
24275---------------
24276
24277 frontend front-http
24278 mode http
24279 bind *:80
24280 bind *:
24281
24282 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
24283 default_backend back-static
24284
24285 backend back-static
24286 mode http
24287 server www A.B.C.D:80
24288
24289 backend back-dynamic
24290 mode http
24291 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
24292 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
24293
24294 fcgi-app php-fpm
24295 log-stderr global
24296 option keep-conn
24297
24298 docroot /var/www/my-app
24299 index index.php
24300 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
24301
24302
2430310.2. Default parameters
24304------------------------
24305
24306A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
24307the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024308script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024309applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
24310
24311 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24312 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
24313 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
24314 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
24315 | | |
24316 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24317 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
24318 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
24319 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
24320 | | application. |
24321 | | |
24322 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24323 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
24324 | | the request. It may not be set. |
24325 | | |
24326 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24327 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
24328 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
24329 | | the application's configuration. |
24330 | | |
24331 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24332 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
24333 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
24334 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
24335 | | |
24336 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24337 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
24338 | | following the part that identifies the script |
24339 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
24340 | | be defined. |
24341 | | |
24342 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24343 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
24344 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
24345 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
24346 | | is not set too. |
24347 | | |
24348 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24349 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
24350 | | set. |
24351 | | |
24352 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24353 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
24354 | | the request. |
24355 | | |
24356 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24357 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
24358 | | client as part of user authentication. |
24359 | | |
24360 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24361 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
24362 | | script to process the request. |
24363 | | |
24364 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24365 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
24366 | | |
24367 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24368 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
24369 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
24370 | | |
24371 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24372 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
24373 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
24374 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
24375 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
24376 | | |
24377 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24378 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
24379 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
24380 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
24381 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
24382 | | side. |
24383 | | |
24384 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24385 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
24386 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
24387 | | connected to. |
24388 | | |
24389 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24390 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
24391 | | |
24392 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020024393 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
24394 | | current HAProxy version. |
24395 | | |
24396 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024397 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
24398 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
24399 | | |
24400 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24401
24402
2440310.3. Limitations
24404------------------
24405
24406The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
24407way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
24408during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
24409establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
24410application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
24411or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
24412message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
24413these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
24414and HTTP servers under the same backend.
24415
24416Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
24417request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
24418requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
24419
24420About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
24421into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
24422fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
24423"http-request" ones.
24424
24425Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
24426FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
24427processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
24428must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
24429here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010024430
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024431
2443211. Address formats
24433-------------------
24434
24435Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
24436address.
24437
24438This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
24439The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
24440of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
24441equivalent is '::'.
24442
24443Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
24444is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
24445
24446This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
24447family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
24448
24449Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
24450configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
24451use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
24452'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
24453
24454Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
24455socket type and the transport method.
24456
24457
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002445811.1. Address family prefixes
24459-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024460
24461'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
24462
24463'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
24464 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
24465 listening.
24466
24467'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
24468 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
24469 on the statement using this address, a port or
24470 a port range may or must be specified.
24471
24472'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24473 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
24474 using this address, a port or a port range
24475 may or must be specified.
24476
24477'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24478 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
24479 using this address, a port or a port range
24480 may or must be specified.
24481
24482'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
24483 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
24484 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
24485 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
24486 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
24487 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
24488
24489'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
24490 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
24491 start by slash '/'.
24492
24493
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002449411.2. Socket type prefixes
24495--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024496
24497Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
24498type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
24499this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
24500This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
24501but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
24502
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024503Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should instead use
24504use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes". However these can
24505sometimes be convenient, for example in combination with inherited sockets
24506known by their file descriptor number, in which case the address family is "fd"
24507and the socket type must be declared.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024508
24509If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
24510they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
24511report this to the maintainers.
24512
24513'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24514 to "stream"
24515
24516'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24517 to "datagram".
24518
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024519'quic+<family>@<address>' forces socket type to "datagram" and transport
24520 method to "stream".
24521
24522
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024523
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002452411.3. Protocol prefixes
24525-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024526
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024527'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24528 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
24529 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24530 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24531 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024532 must be specified. It is equivalent to
24533 "quic+ipv4@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024534
24535'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24536 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
24537 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24538 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24539 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024540 must be specified. It is equivalent to
24541 "quic+ipv6@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024542
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024543'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24544 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24545 socket type and transport method is forced to
24546 "stream". Depending on the statement using
24547 this address, a port or a port range can or
24548 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24549 of 'stream+ip@'.
24550
24551'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24552 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24553 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24554 statement using this address, a port or port
24555 range can or must be specified.
24556 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24557
24558'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24559 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24560 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24561 statement using this address, a port or port
24562 range can or must be specified.
24563 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24564
24565'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24566 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24567 socket type and transport method is forced to
24568 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
24569 this address, a port or a port range can or
24570 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24571 of 'dgram+ip@'.
24572
24573'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24574 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24575 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24576 the statement using this address, a port or
24577 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010024578 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024579
24580'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24581 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24582 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24583 the statement using this address, a port or
24584 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010024585 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024586
24587'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24588 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
24589 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
24590
24591'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24592 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
24593 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
24594
24595In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
24596QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
24597
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010024598/*
24599 * Local variables:
24600 * fill-column: 79
24601 * End:
24602 */